gdb/
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
488 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
489 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
490 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
491 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
492 trad unwinders. The architecture specific changes, each involving a
493 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
494 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
495 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
496 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
497 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
498 Weigand.
499
500 @node Sample Session
501 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
502
503 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
504 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
505 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
506
507 @iftex
508 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
509 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
510 @end iftex
511
512 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
513 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
514
515 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
516 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
517 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
518 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
519 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
520 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
521 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
522 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
523 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
524
525 @smallexample
526 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
527 $ @b{./m4}
528 @b{define(foo,0000)}
529
530 @b{foo}
531 0000
532 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
533
534 @b{bar}
535 0000
536 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
537
538 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
539 @b{baz}
540 @b{C-d}
541 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
542 @end smallexample
543
544 @noindent
545 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
546
547 @smallexample
548 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
549 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
550 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
551 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
552 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
553 the conditions.
554 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
555 for details.
556
557 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
558 (@value{GDBP})
559 @end smallexample
560
561 @noindent
562 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
563 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
564 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
565 that examples fit in this manual.
566
567 @smallexample
568 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
569 @end smallexample
570
571 @noindent
572 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
573 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
574 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
575 @code{break} command.
576
577 @smallexample
578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
579 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
580 @end smallexample
581
582 @noindent
583 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
584 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
585 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
586
587 @smallexample
588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
589 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
590 @b{define(foo,0000)}
591
592 @b{foo}
593 0000
594 @end smallexample
595
596 @noindent
597 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
598 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
599 context where it stops.
600
601 @smallexample
602 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
603
604 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
605 at builtin.c:879
606 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
611 the next line of the current function.
612
613 @smallexample
614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
615 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
616 : nil,
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
621 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
622 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
623 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
624
625 @smallexample
626 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
627 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
628 at input.c:530
629 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
634 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
635 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
636 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
637 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
638 stack frame for each active subroutine.
639
640 @smallexample
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
642 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
643 at input.c:530
644 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
645 at builtin.c:882
646 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
647 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
648 at macro.c:71
649 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
650 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
655 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
656 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
657
658 @smallexample
659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
660 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
661 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
662 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
663 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
665 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
666 : xstrdup(rq);
667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
668 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
673 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
674 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
675 (@code{print}) to see their values.
676
677 @smallexample
678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
679 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
681 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
686 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
687 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
691 533 xfree(rquote);
692 534
693 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
694 : xstrdup (lq);
695 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
696 : xstrdup (rq);
697 537
698 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
699 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
700 540 @}
701 541
702 542 void
703 @end smallexample
704
705 @noindent
706 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
707 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
708
709 @smallexample
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
711 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
713 540 @}
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
715 $3 = 9
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
717 $4 = 7
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
722 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
723 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
724 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
725 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
726 assignments.
727
728 @smallexample
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
730 $5 = 7
731 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
732 $6 = 9
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
737 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
738 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
739 example that caused trouble initially:
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
743 Continuing.
744
745 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
746
747 baz
748 0000
749 @end smallexample
750
751 @noindent
752 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
753 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
754 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
755
756 @smallexample
757 @b{C-d}
758 Program exited normally.
759 @end smallexample
760
761 @noindent
762 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
763 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
764 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
765
766 @smallexample
767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
768 @end smallexample
769
770 @node Invocation
771 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
772
773 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
774 The essentials are:
775 @itemize @bullet
776 @item
777 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
778 @item
779 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
780 @end itemize
781
782 @menu
783 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
784 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
785 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
786 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
787 @end menu
788
789 @node Invoking GDB
790 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
791
792 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
793 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
794
795 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
796 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
797
798 The command-line options described here are designed
799 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
800 options may effectively be unavailable.
801
802 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
803 specifying an executable program:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
807 @end smallexample
808
809 @noindent
810 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
811 specified:
812
813 @smallexample
814 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
815 @end smallexample
816
817 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
818 to debug a running process:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @noindent
825 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
826 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
827
828 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
829 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
830 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
831 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
832 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
833
834 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
835 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
836 option processing.
837 @smallexample
838 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
839 @end smallexample
840 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
841 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
842
843 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
844 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
845
846 @smallexample
847 @value{GDBP} -silent
848 @end smallexample
849
850 @noindent
851 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
852 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
853
854 @noindent
855 Type
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} -help
859 @end smallexample
860
861 @noindent
862 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
863 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
864
865 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
866 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
867 @samp{-x} option is used.
868
869
870 @menu
871 * File Options:: Choosing files
872 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
873 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
874 @end menu
875
876 @node File Options
877 @subsection Choosing files
878
879 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
880 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
881 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
882 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
883 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
884 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
885 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
886 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
887 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
888 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
889 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
890 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
891 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
892
893 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
894 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
895 argument and ignore it.
896
897 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
898 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
899 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
900 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
901 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
902
903 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
904 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
905 @c it.
906
907 @table @code
908 @item -symbols @var{file}
909 @itemx -s @var{file}
910 @cindex @code{--symbols}
911 @cindex @code{-s}
912 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
913
914 @item -exec @var{file}
915 @itemx -e @var{file}
916 @cindex @code{--exec}
917 @cindex @code{-e}
918 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
919 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
920
921 @item -se @var{file}
922 @cindex @code{--se}
923 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
924 file.
925
926 @item -core @var{file}
927 @itemx -c @var{file}
928 @cindex @code{--core}
929 @cindex @code{-c}
930 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
931
932 @item -c @var{number}
933 @item -pid @var{number}
934 @itemx -p @var{number}
935 @cindex @code{--pid}
936 @cindex @code{-p}
937 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
938 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
939 file named @var{number}.
940
941 @item -command @var{file}
942 @itemx -x @var{file}
943 @cindex @code{--command}
944 @cindex @code{-x}
945 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
946 Files,, Command files}.
947
948 @item -eval-command @var{command}
949 @itemx -ex @var{command}
950 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
951 @cindex @code{-ex}
952 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
953
954 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
955 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
956
957 @smallexample
958 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
959 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
960 @end smallexample
961
962 @item -directory @var{directory}
963 @itemx -d @var{directory}
964 @cindex @code{--directory}
965 @cindex @code{-d}
966 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
967
968 @item -r
969 @itemx -readnow
970 @cindex @code{--readnow}
971 @cindex @code{-r}
972 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
973 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
974 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
975
976 @end table
977
978 @node Mode Options
979 @subsection Choosing modes
980
981 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
982 batch mode or quiet mode.
983
984 @table @code
985 @item -nx
986 @itemx -n
987 @cindex @code{--nx}
988 @cindex @code{-n}
989 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
990 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
991 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
992 files}.
993
994 @item -quiet
995 @itemx -silent
996 @itemx -q
997 @cindex @code{--quiet}
998 @cindex @code{--silent}
999 @cindex @code{-q}
1000 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1001 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1002
1003 @item -batch
1004 @cindex @code{--batch}
1005 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1006 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1007 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1008 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1009 in the command files.
1010
1011 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1012 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1013 make this more useful, the message
1014
1015 @smallexample
1016 Program exited normally.
1017 @end smallexample
1018
1019 @noindent
1020 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1021 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1022 mode.
1023
1024 @item -batch-silent
1025 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1026 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1027 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1028 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1029 for an interactive session.
1030
1031 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1032 messages, for example.
1033
1034 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1035 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1036
1037 @item -return-child-result
1038 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1039 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1040 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1041
1042 @itemize @bullet
1043 @item
1044 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1045 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1046 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1047 @item
1048 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1049 @item
1050 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1051 the exit code will be -1.
1052 @end itemize
1053
1054 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1055 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1056 interface.
1057
1058 @item -nowindows
1059 @itemx -nw
1060 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1061 @cindex @code{-nw}
1062 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1063 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1064 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1065
1066 @item -windows
1067 @itemx -w
1068 @cindex @code{--windows}
1069 @cindex @code{-w}
1070 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1071 used if possible.
1072
1073 @item -cd @var{directory}
1074 @cindex @code{--cd}
1075 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1076 instead of the current directory.
1077
1078 @item -fullname
1079 @itemx -f
1080 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1081 @cindex @code{-f}
1082 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1083 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1084 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1085 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1086 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1087 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1088 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1089 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1090 frame.
1091
1092 @item -epoch
1093 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1094 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1095 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1096 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1097 separate window.
1098
1099 @item -annotate @var{level}
1100 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1101 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1102 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1103 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1104 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1105 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1106 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1107 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1108 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1109
1110 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1111 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1112
1113 @item --args
1114 @cindex @code{--args}
1115 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1116 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1117 This option stops option processing.
1118
1119 @item -baud @var{bps}
1120 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1121 @cindex @code{--baud}
1122 @cindex @code{-b}
1123 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1124 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1125
1126 @item -l @var{timeout}
1127 @cindex @code{-l}
1128 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1129 for remote debugging.
1130
1131 @item -tty @var{device}
1132 @itemx -t @var{device}
1133 @cindex @code{--tty}
1134 @cindex @code{-t}
1135 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1136 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1137
1138 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1139 @item -tui
1140 @cindex @code{--tui}
1141 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1142 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1143 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1144 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1145 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1146 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1147 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1148
1149 @c @item -xdb
1150 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1151 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1152 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1153 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1154 @c systems.
1155
1156 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1157 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1158 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1159 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1160 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1161 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1162
1163 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1164 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1165 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1166 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1167 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1168 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1169
1170 @item -write
1171 @cindex @code{--write}
1172 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1173 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1174 (@pxref{Patching}).
1175
1176 @item -statistics
1177 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1178 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1179 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1180
1181 @item -version
1182 @cindex @code{--version}
1183 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1184 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1185
1186 @end table
1187
1188 @node Startup
1189 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1190 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1191
1192 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1193
1194 @enumerate
1195 @item
1196 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1197 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1198
1199 @item
1200 @cindex init file
1201 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1202 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1203 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1204 that file.
1205
1206 @item
1207 Processes command line options and operands.
1208
1209 @item
1210 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1211 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1212 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1213 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1214 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1215 @value{GDBN}.
1216
1217 @item
1218 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1219 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1220
1221 @item
1222 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1223 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1224 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1225 @end enumerate
1226
1227 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1228 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1229 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1230 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1231 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1232 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1233
1234 @cindex init file name
1235 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1236 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1237 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1238 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1239 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1240 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1241 environments with special init file names:
1242
1243 @itemize @bullet
1244 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1245 @item
1246 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1247 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1248 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1249 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1250 the file to the standard name.
1251
1252 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1253 @item
1254 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1255
1256 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1257 @item
1258 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1259
1260 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1261 @item
1262 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1263
1264 @item
1265 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1266 @end itemize
1267
1268
1269 @node Quitting GDB
1270 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1271 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1272 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1273
1274 @table @code
1275 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1276 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1277 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1278 @itemx q
1279 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1280 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1281 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1282 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1283 error code.
1284 @end table
1285
1286 @cindex interrupt
1287 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1288 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1289 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1290 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1291 until a time when it is safe.
1292
1293 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1294 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1295 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1296
1297 @node Shell Commands
1298 @section Shell commands
1299
1300 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1301 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1302 just use the @code{shell} command.
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex shell
1306 @cindex shell escape
1307 @item shell @var{command string}
1308 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1309 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1310 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1311 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1312 @end table
1313
1314 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1315 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1316 @value{GDBN}:
1317
1318 @table @code
1319 @kindex make
1320 @cindex calling make
1321 @item make @var{make-args}
1322 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1323 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1324 @end table
1325
1326 @node Logging output
1327 @section Logging output
1328 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1329 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1330
1331 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1332 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1333
1334 @table @code
1335 @kindex set logging
1336 @item set logging on
1337 Enable logging.
1338 @item set logging off
1339 Disable logging.
1340 @cindex logging file name
1341 @item set logging file @var{file}
1342 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1343 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1344 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1345 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1346 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1347 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1348 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1349 @kindex show logging
1350 @item show logging
1351 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1352 @end table
1353
1354 @node Commands
1355 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1356
1357 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1358 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1359 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1360 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1361 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1362
1363 @menu
1364 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1365 * Completion:: Command completion
1366 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1367 @end menu
1368
1369 @node Command Syntax
1370 @section Command syntax
1371
1372 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1373 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1374 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1375 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1376 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1377 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1378
1379 @cindex abbreviation
1380 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1381 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1382 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1383 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1384 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1385 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1386 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1387
1388 @cindex repeating commands
1389 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1390 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1391 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1392 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1393 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1394 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1395 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1396
1397 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1398 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1399 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1400
1401 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1402 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1403 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1404 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1405 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1406
1407 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1408 @cindex comment
1409 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1410 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1411 Files,,Command files}).
1412
1413 @cindex repeating command sequences
1414 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1415 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1416 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1417 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1418 for editing.
1419
1420 @node Completion
1421 @section Command completion
1422
1423 @cindex completion
1424 @cindex word completion
1425 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1426 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1427 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1428 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1429
1430 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1431 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1432 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1433 enter it). For example, if you type
1434
1435 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1436 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1437 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1438 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1439 @smallexample
1440 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1441 @end smallexample
1442
1443 @noindent
1444 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1445 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1446
1447 @smallexample
1448 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1449 @end smallexample
1450
1451 @noindent
1452 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1453 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1454 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1455 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1456 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1457 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1458
1459 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1460 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1461 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1462 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1463 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1464 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1465 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1466 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1467 example:
1468
1469 @smallexample
1470 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1471 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1472 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1473 make_abs_section make_function_type
1474 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1475 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1476 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1477 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1478 @end smallexample
1479
1480 @noindent
1481 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1482 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1483 command.
1484
1485 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1486 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1487 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1488 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1489 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1490
1491 @cindex quotes in commands
1492 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1493 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1494 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1495 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1496 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1497 @value{GDBN} commands.
1498
1499 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1500 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1501 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1502 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1503 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1504 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1505 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1506 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1507 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1508 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1509 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1513 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1518 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1519 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1520 place:
1521
1522 @smallexample
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1524 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1525 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1526 @end smallexample
1527
1528 @noindent
1529 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1530 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1531 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1532
1533 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1534 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1535 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1536 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1537
1538
1539 @node Help
1540 @section Getting help
1541 @cindex online documentation
1542 @kindex help
1543
1544 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1545 using the command @code{help}.
1546
1547 @table @code
1548 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1549 @item help
1550 @itemx h
1551 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1552 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1553
1554 @smallexample
1555 (@value{GDBP}) help
1556 List of classes of commands:
1557
1558 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1559 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1560 data -- Examining data
1561 files -- Specifying and examining files
1562 internals -- Maintenance commands
1563 obscure -- Obscure features
1564 running -- Running the program
1565 stack -- Examining the stack
1566 status -- Status inquiries
1567 support -- Support facilities
1568 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1569 stopping the program
1570 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1571
1572 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1573 commands in that class.
1574 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1575 documentation.
1576 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1577 (@value{GDBP})
1578 @end smallexample
1579 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1580
1581 @item help @var{class}
1582 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1583 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1584 help display for the class @code{status}:
1585
1586 @smallexample
1587 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1588 Status inquiries.
1589
1590 List of commands:
1591
1592 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1593 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1594 info -- Generic command for showing things
1595 about the program being debugged
1596 show -- Generic command for showing things
1597 about the debugger
1598
1599 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1600 documentation.
1601 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1602 (@value{GDBP})
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @item help @var{command}
1606 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1607 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1608
1609 @kindex apropos
1610 @item apropos @var{args}
1611 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1612 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1613 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1614
1615 @smallexample
1616 apropos reload
1617 @end smallexample
1618
1619 @noindent
1620 results in:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 @c @group
1624 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1625 multiple times in one run
1626 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1627 multiple times in one run
1628 @c @end group
1629 @end smallexample
1630
1631 @kindex complete
1632 @item complete @var{args}
1633 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1634 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1635 command you want completed. For example:
1636
1637 @smallexample
1638 complete i
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @noindent results in:
1642
1643 @smallexample
1644 @group
1645 if
1646 ignore
1647 info
1648 inspect
1649 @end group
1650 @end smallexample
1651
1652 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1653 @end table
1654
1655 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1656 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1657 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1658 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1659 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1660 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1661
1662 @c @group
1663 @table @code
1664 @kindex info
1665 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1666 @item info
1667 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1668 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1669 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1670 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1671 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1672 @w{@code{help info}}.
1673
1674 @kindex set
1675 @item set
1676 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1677 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1678 @code{set prompt $}.
1679
1680 @kindex show
1681 @item show
1682 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1683 @value{GDBN} itself.
1684 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1685 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1686 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1687 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1688
1689 @kindex info set
1690 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1691 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1692 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1693 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1694 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1695 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1696 @end table
1697 @c @end group
1698
1699 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1700 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1701
1702 @table @code
1703 @kindex show version
1704 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1705 @item show version
1706 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1707 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1708 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1709 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1710 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1711 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1712 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1713 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1714 @value{GDBN}.
1715
1716 @kindex show copying
1717 @kindex info copying
1718 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1719 @item show copying
1720 @itemx info copying
1721 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1722
1723 @kindex show warranty
1724 @kindex info warranty
1725 @item show warranty
1726 @itemx info warranty
1727 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1728 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1729
1730 @end table
1731
1732 @node Running
1733 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1734
1735 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1736 debugging information when you compile it.
1737
1738 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1739 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1740 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1741 kill a child process.
1742
1743 @menu
1744 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1745 * Starting:: Starting your program
1746 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1747 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1748
1749 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1750 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1751 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1752 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1753
1754 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1755 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1756 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1757 @end menu
1758
1759 @node Compilation
1760 @section Compiling for debugging
1761
1762 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1763 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1764 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1765 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1766 and addresses in the executable code.
1767
1768 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1769 the compiler.
1770
1771 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1772 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1773 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1774 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1775 executables containing debugging information.
1776
1777 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1778 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1779 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1780 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1781 in pushing your luck.
1782
1783 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1784 @cindex debugging optimized code
1785 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1786 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1787 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1788 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1789 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1790 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1791
1792 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1793 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1794 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1795 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1796 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1797
1798 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1799 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1800 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1801
1802 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1803 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1804 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1805 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1806 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1807 provides macro information if you specify the options
1808 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1809 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1810 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1811 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1812 @option{-g} alone.
1813
1814 @need 2000
1815 @node Starting
1816 @section Starting your program
1817 @cindex starting
1818 @cindex running
1819
1820 @table @code
1821 @kindex run
1822 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1823 @item run
1824 @itemx r
1825 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1826 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1827 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1828 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1829 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1830
1831 @end table
1832
1833 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1834 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1835 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1836 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1837
1838 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1839 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1840 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1841 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1842 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1843 divided into four categories:
1844
1845 @table @asis
1846 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1847 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1848 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1849 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1850 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1851 the arguments.
1852 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1853 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1854 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1855
1856 @item The @emph{environment.}
1857 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1858 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1859 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1860 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1861
1862 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1863 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1864 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1865 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1866
1867 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1868 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1869 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1870 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1871 set a different device for your program.
1872 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1873
1874 @cindex pipes
1875 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1876 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1877 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1878 wrong program.
1879 @end table
1880
1881 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1882 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1883 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1884 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1885 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1886
1887 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1888 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1889 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1890 your current breakpoints.
1891
1892 @table @code
1893 @kindex start
1894 @item start
1895 @cindex run to main procedure
1896 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1897 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1898 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1899 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1900 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1901 procedure, depending on the language used.
1902
1903 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1904 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1905 the @samp{run} command.
1906
1907 @cindex elaboration phase
1908 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1909 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1910 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1911 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1912 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1913 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1914 will remain to halt execution.
1915
1916 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1917 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1918 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1919 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1920 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1921
1922 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1923 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1924 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1925 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1926 elaboration code before running your program.
1927 @end table
1928
1929 @node Arguments
1930 @section Your program's arguments
1931
1932 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1933 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1934 @code{run} command.
1935 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1936 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1937 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1938 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1939 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1940
1941 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1942 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1943 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1944 the program, not by the shell.
1945
1946 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1947 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1948
1949 @table @code
1950 @kindex set args
1951 @item set args
1952 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1953 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1954 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1955 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1956 it again without arguments.
1957
1958 @kindex show args
1959 @item show args
1960 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1961 @end table
1962
1963 @node Environment
1964 @section Your program's environment
1965
1966 @cindex environment (of your program)
1967 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1968 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1969 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1970 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1971 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1972 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1973 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1974
1975 @table @code
1976 @kindex path
1977 @item path @var{directory}
1978 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1979 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1980 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1981 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1982 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1983 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1984 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1985
1986 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1987 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1988 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1989 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1990 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1991 @var{directory} to the search path.
1992 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1993 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1994
1995 @kindex show paths
1996 @item show paths
1997 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1998 environment variable).
1999
2000 @kindex show environment
2001 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2002 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2003 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2004 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2005 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2006
2007 @kindex set environment
2008 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2009 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2010 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2011 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2012 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2013 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2014 null value.
2015 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2016 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2017
2018 For example, this command:
2019
2020 @smallexample
2021 set env USER = foo
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2026 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2027 are not actually required.)
2028
2029 @kindex unset environment
2030 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2031 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2032 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2033 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2034 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2035 @end table
2036
2037 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2038 the shell indicated
2039 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2040 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2041 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2042 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2043 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2044 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2045 @file{.profile}.
2046
2047 @node Working Directory
2048 @section Your program's working directory
2049
2050 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2051 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2052 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2053 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2054 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2055 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2056
2057 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2058 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2059 specify files}.
2060
2061 @table @code
2062 @kindex cd
2063 @cindex change working directory
2064 @item cd @var{directory}
2065 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2066
2067 @kindex pwd
2068 @item pwd
2069 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2070 @end table
2071
2072 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2073 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2074 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2075 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2076 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2077 current working directory of the debuggee.
2078
2079 @node Input/Output
2080 @section Your program's input and output
2081
2082 @cindex redirection
2083 @cindex i/o
2084 @cindex terminal
2085 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2086 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2087 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2088 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2089 running your program.
2090
2091 @table @code
2092 @kindex info terminal
2093 @item info terminal
2094 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2095 program is using.
2096 @end table
2097
2098 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2099 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2100
2101 @smallexample
2102 run > outfile
2103 @end smallexample
2104
2105 @noindent
2106 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2107
2108 @kindex tty
2109 @cindex controlling terminal
2110 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2111 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2112 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2113 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2114 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2115
2116 @smallexample
2117 tty /dev/ttyb
2118 @end smallexample
2119
2120 @noindent
2121 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2122 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2123 that as their controlling terminal.
2124
2125 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2126 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2127 terminal.
2128
2129 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2130 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2131 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2132 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2133
2134 @cindex inferior tty
2135 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2136 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2137 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2138 program.
2139
2140 @table @code
2141 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2142 @kindex set inferior-tty
2143 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2144
2145 @item show inferior-tty
2146 @kindex show inferior-tty
2147 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2148 @end table
2149
2150 @node Attach
2151 @section Debugging an already-running process
2152 @kindex attach
2153 @cindex attach
2154
2155 @table @code
2156 @item attach @var{process-id}
2157 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2158 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2159 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2160 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2161 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2162
2163 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2164 executing the command.
2165 @end table
2166
2167 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2168 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2169 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2170 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2171
2172 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2173 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2174 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2175 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2176 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2177 Specify Files}.
2178
2179 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2180 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2181 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2182 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2183 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2184 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2185 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2186
2187 @table @code
2188 @kindex detach
2189 @item detach
2190 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2191 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2192 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2193 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2194 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2195 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2196 executing the command.
2197 @end table
2198
2199 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2200 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2201 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2202 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2203 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2204 messages}).
2205
2206 @node Kill Process
2207 @section Killing the child process
2208
2209 @table @code
2210 @kindex kill
2211 @item kill
2212 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2213 @end table
2214
2215 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2216 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2217 is running.
2218
2219 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2220 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2221 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2222 outside the debugger.
2223
2224 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2225 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2226 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2227 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2228 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2229 breakpoint settings).
2230
2231 @node Threads
2232 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2233
2234 @cindex threads of execution
2235 @cindex multiple threads
2236 @cindex switching threads
2237 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2238 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2239 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2240 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2241 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2242 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2243 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2244
2245 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2246 programs:
2247
2248 @itemize @bullet
2249 @item automatic notification of new threads
2250 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2251 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2252 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2253 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2254 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2255 @end itemize
2256
2257 @quotation
2258 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2259 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2260 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2261 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2262 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2263 like this:
2264
2265 @smallexample
2266 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2267 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2268 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2269 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2270 @end smallexample
2271 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2272 @c doesn't support threads"?
2273 @end quotation
2274
2275 @cindex focus of debugging
2276 @cindex current thread
2277 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2278 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2279 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2280 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2281 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2282
2283 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2284 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2285 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2286 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2287 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2288 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2289 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2290 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2291 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2292 LynxOS, you might see
2293
2294 @smallexample
2295 [New process 35 thread 27]
2296 @end smallexample
2297
2298 @noindent
2299 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2300 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2301 further qualifier.
2302
2303 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2304 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2305 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2306 @c program?
2307 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2308 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2309 @c threads ab initio?
2310
2311 @cindex thread number
2312 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2313 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2314 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2315
2316 @table @code
2317 @kindex info threads
2318 @item info threads
2319 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2320 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2321
2322 @enumerate
2323 @item
2324 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2325
2326 @item
2327 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2328
2329 @item
2330 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2331 @end enumerate
2332
2333 @noindent
2334 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2335 indicates the current thread.
2336
2337 For example,
2338 @end table
2339 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2340
2341 @smallexample
2342 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2343 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2344 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2345 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2346 at threadtest.c:68
2347 @end smallexample
2348
2349 On HP-UX systems:
2350
2351 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2352 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2353 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2354 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2355 thread in your program.
2356
2357 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2358 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2359 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2360 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2361 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2362 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2363 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2364 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2365 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2366 HP-UX, you see
2367
2368 @smallexample
2369 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2370 @end smallexample
2371
2372 @noindent
2373 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2374
2375 @table @code
2376 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2377 @item info threads
2378 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2379 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2380
2381 @enumerate
2382 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2383
2384 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2385
2386 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2387 @end enumerate
2388
2389 @noindent
2390 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2391 indicates the current thread.
2392
2393 For example,
2394 @end table
2395 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2396
2397 @smallexample
2398 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2399 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2400 at quicksort.c:137
2401 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2402 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2403 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2404 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2405 @end smallexample
2406
2407 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2408 Solaris-specific command:
2409
2410 @table @code
2411 @item maint info sol-threads
2412 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2413 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2414 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2415 @end table
2416
2417 @table @code
2418 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2419 @item thread @var{threadno}
2420 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2421 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2422 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2423 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2424 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2425
2426 @smallexample
2427 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2428 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2429 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2430 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2431 @end smallexample
2432
2433 @noindent
2434 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2435 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2436 threads.
2437
2438 @kindex thread apply
2439 @cindex apply command to several threads
2440 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2441 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2442 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2443 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2444 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2445 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2446 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2447 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2448 @end table
2449
2450 @cindex automatic thread selection
2451 @cindex switching threads automatically
2452 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2453 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2454 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2455 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2456 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2457 thread.
2458
2459 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2460 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2461 programs with multiple threads.
2462
2463 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2464 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2465
2466 @node Processes
2467 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2468
2469 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2470 @cindex multiple processes
2471 @cindex processes, multiple
2472 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2473 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2474 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2475 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2476 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2477 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2478 will cause it to terminate.
2479
2480 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2481 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2482 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2483 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2484 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2485 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2486 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2487 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2488 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2489 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2490
2491 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2492 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2493 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2494 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2495
2496 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2497 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2498
2499 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2500 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2501
2502 @table @code
2503 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2504 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2505 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2506 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2507 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2508
2509 @table @code
2510 @item parent
2511 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2512 unimpeded. This is the default.
2513
2514 @item child
2515 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2516 unimpeded.
2517
2518 @end table
2519
2520 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2521 @item show follow-fork-mode
2522 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2523 @end table
2524
2525 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2526 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2527 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2528
2529 @table @code
2530 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2531 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2532 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2533 retain debugger control over them both.
2534
2535 @table @code
2536 @item on
2537 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2538 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2539 independently. This is the default.
2540
2541 @item off
2542 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2543 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2544 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2545 is held suspended.
2546
2547 @end table
2548
2549 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2550 @item show detach-on-follow
2551 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2552 @end table
2553
2554 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2555 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2556 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2557 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2558 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2559
2560 @table @code
2561 @kindex info forks
2562 @item info forks
2563 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2564 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2565 position (program counter) of the process.
2566
2567
2568 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2569 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2570 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2571 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2572 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2573
2574 @end table
2575
2576 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2577 from it by using the @w{@code{detach-fork}} command (allowing it to
2578 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2579 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2580
2581 @table @code
2582 @kindex detach-fork @var{fork-id}
2583 @item detach-fork @var{fork-id}
2584 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2585 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2586 allowed to run independently.
2587
2588 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2589 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2590 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2591 and remove it from the fork list.
2592
2593 @end table
2594
2595 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2596 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2597 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2598 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2599 the child process's @code{main}.
2600
2601 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2602 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2603
2604 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2605 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2606 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2607 argument.
2608
2609 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2610 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2611 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2612
2613 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2614 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2615
2616 @cindex checkpoint
2617 @cindex restart
2618 @cindex bookmark
2619 @cindex snapshot of a process
2620 @cindex rewind program state
2621
2622 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2623 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2624 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2625 later.
2626
2627 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2628 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2629 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2630 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2631 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2632
2633 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2634 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2635 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2636 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2637 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2638 start again from there.
2639
2640 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2641 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2642
2643 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2644
2645 @table @code
2646 @kindex checkpoint
2647 @item checkpoint
2648 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2649 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2650 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2651
2652 @kindex info checkpoints
2653 @item info checkpoints
2654 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2655 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2656 listed:
2657
2658 @table @code
2659 @item Checkpoint ID
2660 @item Process ID
2661 @item Code Address
2662 @item Source line, or label
2663 @end table
2664
2665 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2666 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2667 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2668 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2669 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2670 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2671 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2672
2673 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2674 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2675 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2676 the debugger.
2677
2678 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2679 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2680 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2681
2682 @end table
2683
2684 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2685 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2686 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2687 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2688 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2689 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2690 previously read data can be read again.
2691
2692 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2693 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2694 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2695 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2696 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2697 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2698
2699 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2700 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2701 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2702 different execution path this time.
2703
2704 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2705 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2706 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2707 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2708 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2709 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2710 potentially pose a problem.
2711
2712 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2713
2714 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2715 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2716 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2717 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2718 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2719 next.
2720
2721 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2722 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2723 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2724 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2725 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2726
2727 @node Stopping
2728 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2729
2730 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2731 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2732 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2733
2734 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2735 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2736 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2737 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2738 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2739 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2740 explicitly request this information at any time.
2741
2742 @table @code
2743 @kindex info program
2744 @item info program
2745 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2746 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2747 @end table
2748
2749 @menu
2750 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2751 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2752 * Signals:: Signals
2753 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2754 @end menu
2755
2756 @node Breakpoints
2757 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2758
2759 @cindex breakpoints
2760 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2761 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2762 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2763 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2764 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2765 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2766 program.
2767
2768 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2769 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2770 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2771 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2772 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2773 call).
2774
2775 @cindex watchpoints
2776 @cindex memory tracing
2777 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2778 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2779 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2780 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2781 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2782 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2783 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2784 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2785
2786 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2787 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2788 Automatic display}.
2789
2790 @cindex catchpoints
2791 @cindex breakpoint on events
2792 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2793 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2794 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2795 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2796 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2797 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2798 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2799
2800 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2801 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2802 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2803 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2804 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2805 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2806 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2807 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2808 enable it again.
2809
2810 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2811 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2812 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2813 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2814 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2815 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2816 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2817
2818 @menu
2819 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2820 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2821 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2822 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2823 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2824 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2825 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2826 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2827 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2828 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2829 @end menu
2830
2831 @node Set Breaks
2832 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2833
2834 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2835 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2836 @c
2837 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2838
2839 @kindex break
2840 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2841 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2842 @cindex latest breakpoint
2843 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2844 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2845 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2846 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2847 convenience variables.
2848
2849 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2850
2851 @table @code
2852 @item break @var{function}
2853 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2854 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2855 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2856 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2857
2858 @item break +@var{offset}
2859 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2860 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2861 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2862 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2863
2864 @item break @var{linenum}
2865 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2866 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2867 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2868 code on that line.
2869
2870 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2871 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2872
2873 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2874 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2875 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2876 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2877 functions.
2878
2879 @item break *@var{address}
2880 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2881 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2882 information or source files.
2883
2884 @item break
2885 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2886 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2887 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2888 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2889 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2890 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2891 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2892 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2893 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2894 inside loops.
2895
2896 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2897 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2898 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2899 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2900 existed when your program stopped.
2901
2902 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2903 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2904 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2905 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2906 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2907 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2908 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2909
2910 @kindex tbreak
2911 @item tbreak @var{args}
2912 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2913 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2914 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2915 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2916
2917 @kindex hbreak
2918 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2919 @item hbreak @var{args}
2920 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2921 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2922 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2923 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2924 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2925 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2926 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2927 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2928 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2929 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2930 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2931 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2932 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2933 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2934 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2935 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2936 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2937
2938
2939 @kindex thbreak
2940 @item thbreak @var{args}
2941 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2942 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2943 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2944 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2945 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2946 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2947 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2948 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2949
2950 @kindex rbreak
2951 @cindex regular expression
2952 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2953 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2954 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2955 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2956 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2957 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2958 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2959 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2960 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2961
2962 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2963 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2964 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2965 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2966 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2967 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2968
2969 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2970 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2971 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2972 classes.
2973
2974 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2975 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2976 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2977
2978 @smallexample
2979 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2980 @end smallexample
2981
2982 @kindex info breakpoints
2983 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2984 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2985 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2986 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2987 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2988 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2989
2990 @table @emph
2991 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2992 @item Type
2993 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2994 @item Disposition
2995 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2996 @item Enabled or Disabled
2997 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2998 that are not enabled.
2999 @item Address
3000 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
3001 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3002 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3003 @item What
3004 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3005 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3006 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3007 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3008 @end table
3009
3010 @noindent
3011 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3012 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3013 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3014 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3015 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3016 valid location.
3017
3018 @noindent
3019 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3020 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3021 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3022 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3023 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3024
3025 @noindent
3026 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3027 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3028 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3029 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3030 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3031 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3032 @end table
3033
3034 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3035 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3036 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3037 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3038
3039 @cindex pending breakpoints
3040 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3041 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3042 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3043 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3044 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3045 gets loaded.
3046
3047 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3048 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3049 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3050 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3051 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3052 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3053
3054 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3055 breakpoint support:
3056
3057 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3058 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3059 @table @code
3060 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3061 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3062 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3063
3064 @item set breakpoint pending on
3065 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3066 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3067
3068 @item set breakpoint pending off
3069 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3070 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3071 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3072
3073 @item show breakpoint pending
3074 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3075 @end table
3076
3077 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3078 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3079 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3080 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3081 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3082 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3083 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3084 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3085 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3086 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3087 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3088 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3089 of these loads could resolve the location.
3090
3091 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3092 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3093 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3094 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3095 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3096 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3097 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3098 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3099
3100
3101 @node Set Watchpoints
3102 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3103
3104 @cindex setting watchpoints
3105 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3106 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3107 this may happen.
3108
3109 @cindex software watchpoints
3110 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3111 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3112 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3113 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3114 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3115 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3116 culprit.)
3117
3118 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3119 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3120 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3121
3122 @table @code
3123 @kindex watch
3124 @item watch @var{expr}
3125 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
3126 is written into by the program and its value changes.
3127
3128 @kindex rwatch
3129 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3130 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3131 by the program.
3132
3133 @kindex awatch
3134 @item awatch @var{expr}
3135 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3136 or written into by the program.
3137
3138 @kindex info watchpoints
3139 @item info watchpoints
3140 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3141 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3142 @end table
3143
3144 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3145 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3146 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3147 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3148 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3149 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3150
3151 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3152 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3153 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3154 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3155 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3156 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3157 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3158 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
3159
3160 @table @code
3161 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3162 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3163 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3164
3165 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3166 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3167 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3168 @end table
3169
3170 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3171 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3172 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3173
3174 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3175
3176 @smallexample
3177 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3178 @end smallexample
3179
3180 @noindent
3181 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3182
3183 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3184 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3185 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3186 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3187 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3188 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3189 will print a message like this:
3190
3191 @smallexample
3192 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3193 @end smallexample
3194
3195 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3196 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3197 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3198 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3199 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3200 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3201 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3202 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3203
3204 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3205 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3206 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3207 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3208 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3209 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3210
3211 @smallexample
3212 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3213 @end smallexample
3214
3215 @noindent
3216 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3217
3218 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3219 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3220 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3221 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3222 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3223 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3224 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3225 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3226 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3227 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3228
3229 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3230 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3231 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3232
3233 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3234 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3235 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3236 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3237 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3238 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3239 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3240 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3241 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3242
3243 @quotation
3244 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3245 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3246 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3247 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3248 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3249 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3250 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3251 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3252 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3253 the expression.
3254
3255 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3256 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3257 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3258 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3259 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3260 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3261 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3262 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3263 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3264 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3265 @end quotation
3266
3267 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3268
3269 @node Set Catchpoints
3270 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3271 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3272 @cindex exception handlers
3273 @cindex event handling
3274
3275 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3276 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3277 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3278
3279 @table @code
3280 @kindex catch
3281 @item catch @var{event}
3282 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3283 @table @code
3284 @item throw
3285 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3286 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3287
3288 @item catch
3289 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3290
3291 @item exec
3292 @cindex break on fork/exec
3293 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3294
3295 @item fork
3296 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3297
3298 @item vfork
3299 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3300
3301 @item load
3302 @itemx load @var{libname}
3303 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3304 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3305 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3306
3307 @item unload
3308 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3309 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3310 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3311 @end table
3312
3313 @item tcatch @var{event}
3314 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3315 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3316
3317 @end table
3318
3319 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3320
3321 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3322 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3323
3324 @itemize @bullet
3325 @item
3326 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3327 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3328 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3329 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3330 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3331 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3332 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3333 disabled within interactive calls.
3334
3335 @item
3336 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3337
3338 @item
3339 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3340 @end itemize
3341
3342 @cindex raise exceptions
3343 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3344 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3345 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3346 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3347 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3348 out where the exception was raised.
3349
3350 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3351 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3352 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3353 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3354
3355 @smallexample
3356 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3357 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3358 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3359 @end smallexample
3360
3361 @noindent
3362 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3363 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3364 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3365
3366 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3367 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3368 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3369 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3370 raised.
3371
3372
3373 @node Delete Breaks
3374 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3375
3376 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3377 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3378 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3379 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3380 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3381 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3382
3383 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3384 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3385 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3386 their breakpoint numbers.
3387
3388 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3389 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3390 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3391
3392 @table @code
3393 @kindex clear
3394 @item clear
3395 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3396 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3397 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3398 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3399
3400 @item clear @var{function}
3401 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3402 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3403
3404 @item clear @var{linenum}
3405 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3406 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3407 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3408
3409 @cindex delete breakpoints
3410 @kindex delete
3411 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3412 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3413 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3414 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3415 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3416 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3417 @end table
3418
3419 @node Disabling
3420 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3421
3422 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3423 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3424 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3425 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3426 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3427
3428 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3429 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3430 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3431 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3432 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3433
3434 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3435 states of enablement:
3436
3437 @itemize @bullet
3438 @item
3439 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3440 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3441 @item
3442 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3443 @item
3444 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3445 disabled.
3446 @item
3447 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3448 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3449 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3450 @end itemize
3451
3452 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3453 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3454
3455 @table @code
3456 @kindex disable
3457 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3458 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3459 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3460 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3461 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3462 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3463 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3464
3465 @kindex enable
3466 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3467 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3468 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3469
3470 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3471 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3472 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3473
3474 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3475 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3476 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3477 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3478 @end table
3479
3480 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3481 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3482 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3483 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3484 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3485 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3486 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3487 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3488 stepping}.)
3489
3490 @node Conditions
3491 @subsection Break conditions
3492 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3493 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3494
3495 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3496 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3497 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3498 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3499 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3500 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3501 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3502 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3503
3504 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3505 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3506 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3507 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3508 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3509
3510 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3511 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3512 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3513 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3514 one.
3515
3516 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3517 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3518 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3519 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3520 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3521 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3522 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3523 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3524 conditions for the
3525 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3526 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3527
3528 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3529 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3530 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3531 with the @code{condition} command.
3532
3533 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3534 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3535 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3536 catchpoint.
3537
3538 @table @code
3539 @kindex condition
3540 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3541 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3542 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3543 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3544 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3545 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3546 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3547 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3548 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3549 prints an error message:
3550
3551 @smallexample
3552 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3553 @end smallexample
3554
3555 @noindent
3556 @value{GDBN} does
3557 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3558 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3559 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3560
3561 @item condition @var{bnum}
3562 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3563 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3564 @end table
3565
3566 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3567 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3568 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3569 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3570 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3571 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3572 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3573 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3574 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3575 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3576 your program reaches it.
3577
3578 @table @code
3579 @kindex ignore
3580 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3581 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3582 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3583 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3584 takes no action.
3585
3586 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3587 a count of zero.
3588
3589 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3590 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3591 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3592 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3593
3594 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3595 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3596 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3597
3598 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3599 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3600 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3601 variables}.
3602 @end table
3603
3604 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3605
3606
3607 @node Break Commands
3608 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3609
3610 @cindex breakpoint commands
3611 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3612 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3613 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3614 enable other breakpoints.
3615
3616 @table @code
3617 @kindex commands
3618 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3619 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3620 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3621 @itemx end
3622 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3623 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3624 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3625
3626 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3627 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3628
3629 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3630 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3631 recently encountered).
3632 @end table
3633
3634 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3635 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3636
3637 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3638 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3639 that resumes execution.
3640
3641 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3642 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3643 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3644 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3645 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3646
3647 @kindex silent
3648 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3649 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3650 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3651 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3652 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3653 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3654
3655 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3656 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3657 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3658
3659 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3660 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3661
3662 @smallexample
3663 break foo if x>0
3664 commands
3665 silent
3666 printf "x is %d\n",x
3667 cont
3668 end
3669 @end smallexample
3670
3671 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3672 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3673 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3674 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3675 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3676 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3677 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3678
3679 @smallexample
3680 break 403
3681 commands
3682 silent
3683 set x = y + 4
3684 cont
3685 end
3686 @end smallexample
3687
3688 @node Breakpoint Menus
3689 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3690 @cindex overloading
3691 @cindex symbol overloading
3692
3693 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3694 single function name
3695 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3696 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3697 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3698 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3699 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3700 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3701 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3702 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3703 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3704 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3705 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3706 breakpoints.
3707
3708 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3709 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3710 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3711
3712 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3713 @smallexample
3714 @group
3715 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3716 [0] cancel
3717 [1] all
3718 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3719 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3720 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3721 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3722 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3723 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3724 > 2 4 6
3725 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3726 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3727 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3728 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3729 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3730 breakpoints.
3731 (@value{GDBP})
3732 @end group
3733 @end smallexample
3734
3735 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3736 @node Error in Breakpoints
3737 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3738 @c
3739 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3740 @c
3741 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3742 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3743 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3744 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3745
3746 @smallexample
3747 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3748 The same program may be running in another process.
3749 @end smallexample
3750
3751 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3752
3753 @enumerate
3754 @item
3755 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3756
3757 @item
3758 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3759 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3760 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3761 Then start your program again.
3762
3763 @item
3764 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3765 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3766 to nonsharable executables.
3767 @end enumerate
3768 @c @end ifclear
3769
3770 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3771 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3772
3773 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3774 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3775 @smallexample
3776 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3777 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3778 @end smallexample
3779
3780 @noindent
3781 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3782 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3783 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3784
3785 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3786 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3787
3788 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3789 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3790 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3791
3792 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3793 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3794 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3795 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3796
3797 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3798 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3799 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3800 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3801 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3802 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3803 first in the bundle.
3804
3805 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3806 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3807 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3808 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3809 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3810 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3811 is hit.
3812
3813 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3814 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3815
3816 @smallexample
3817 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3818 @end smallexample
3819
3820 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3821 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3822 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3823 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3824 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3825 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3826 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3827 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3828
3829 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3830 adjusted breakpoints:
3831
3832 @smallexample
3833 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3834 to 0x00010410.
3835 @end smallexample
3836
3837 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3838 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3839 frequently than expected.
3840
3841 @node Continuing and Stepping
3842 @section Continuing and stepping
3843
3844 @cindex stepping
3845 @cindex continuing
3846 @cindex resuming execution
3847 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3848 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3849 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3850 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3851 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3852 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3853 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3854 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3855
3856 @table @code
3857 @kindex continue
3858 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3859 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3860 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3861 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3862 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3863 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3864 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3865 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3866 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3867 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3868
3869 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3870 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3871 @code{continue} is ignored.
3872
3873 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3874 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3875 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3876 @code{continue}.
3877 @end table
3878
3879 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3880 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3881 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3882 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3883
3884 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3885 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3886 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3887 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3888 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3889 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3890
3891 @table @code
3892 @kindex step
3893 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3894 @item step
3895 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3896 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3897 abbreviated @code{s}.
3898
3899 @quotation
3900 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3901 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3902 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3903 @c distinction here.
3904 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3905 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3906 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3907 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3908 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3909 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3910 below.
3911 @end quotation
3912
3913 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3914 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3915 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3916 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3917 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3918 called within the line.
3919
3920 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3921 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3922 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3923 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3924 was any debugging information about the routine.
3925
3926 @item step @var{count}
3927 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3928 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3929 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3930
3931 @kindex next
3932 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3933 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3934 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3935 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3936 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3937 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3938 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3939 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3940
3941 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3942
3943
3944 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3945 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3946 @c
3947 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3948 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3949 @c function are executed without stopping.
3950
3951 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3952 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3953 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3954
3955 @kindex set step-mode
3956 @item set step-mode
3957 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3958 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3959 @itemx set step-mode on
3960 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3961 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3962 information rather than stepping over it.
3963
3964 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3965 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3966 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3967
3968 @item set step-mode off
3969 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3970 debug information. This is the default.
3971
3972 @item show step-mode
3973 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
3974 source line debug information.
3975
3976 @kindex finish
3977 @item finish
3978 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3979 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3980
3981 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3982 ,Returning from a function}).
3983
3984 @kindex until
3985 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3986 @cindex run until specified location
3987 @item until
3988 @itemx u
3989 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3990 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3991 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3992 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3993 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3994 than the address of the jump.
3995
3996 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3997 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3998 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3999 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4000 through the next iteration.
4001
4002 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4003 stack frame.
4004
4005 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4006 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4007 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4008 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4009 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4010
4011 @smallexample
4012 (@value{GDBP}) f
4013 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4014 206 expand_input();
4015 (@value{GDBP}) until
4016 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4017 @end smallexample
4018
4019 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4020 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4021 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4022 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4023 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4024 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4025 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4026
4027 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4028 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4029 argument.
4030
4031 @item until @var{location}
4032 @itemx u @var{location}
4033 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4034 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4035 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4036 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4037 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4038 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4039 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4040 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4041 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4042 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4043 invocations have returned.
4044
4045 @smallexample
4046 94 int factorial (int value)
4047 95 @{
4048 96 if (value > 1) @{
4049 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4050 98 @}
4051 99 return (value);
4052 100 @}
4053 @end smallexample
4054
4055
4056 @kindex advance @var{location}
4057 @itemx advance @var{location}
4058 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4059 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4060 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4061 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4062 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4063 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4064
4065
4066 @kindex stepi
4067 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4068 @item stepi
4069 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4070 @itemx si
4071 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4072
4073 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4074 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4075 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4076 Display,, Automatic display}.
4077
4078 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4079
4080 @need 750
4081 @kindex nexti
4082 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4083 @item nexti
4084 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4085 @itemx ni
4086 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4087 proceed until the function returns.
4088
4089 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4090 @end table
4091
4092 @node Signals
4093 @section Signals
4094 @cindex signals
4095
4096 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4097 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4098 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4099 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
4100 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4101 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4102 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4103 requested an alarm).
4104
4105 @cindex fatal signals
4106 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4107 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4108 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4109 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4110 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4111 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4112
4113 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4114 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4115 signal.
4116
4117 @cindex handling signals
4118 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4119 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4120 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4121 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4122 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4123
4124 @table @code
4125 @kindex info signals
4126 @kindex info handle
4127 @item info signals
4128 @itemx info handle
4129 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4130 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4131 the defined types of signals.
4132
4133 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4134
4135 @kindex handle
4136 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
4137 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4138 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4139 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4140 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4141 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
4142 @end table
4143
4144 @c @group
4145 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4146 Their full names are:
4147
4148 @table @code
4149 @item nostop
4150 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4151 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4152
4153 @item stop
4154 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4155 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4156
4157 @item print
4158 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4159
4160 @item noprint
4161 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4162 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4163
4164 @item pass
4165 @itemx noignore
4166 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4167 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4168 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4169
4170 @item nopass
4171 @itemx ignore
4172 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4173 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4174 @end table
4175 @c @end group
4176
4177 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4178 program until you
4179 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4180 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4181 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4182 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4183 program sees that signal when you continue.
4184
4185 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4186 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4187 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4188 erroneous signals.
4189
4190 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4191 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4192 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4193 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4194 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4195 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4196 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4197 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4198 program a signal}.
4199
4200 @node Thread Stops
4201 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4202
4203 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4204 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4205 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4206
4207 @table @code
4208 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4209 @cindex thread breakpoints
4210 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4211 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4212 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4213 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4214 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4215
4216 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4217 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4218 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4219 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4220 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4221
4222 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4223 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4224 program.
4225
4226 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4227 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4228 breakpoint condition, like this:
4229
4230 @smallexample
4231 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4232 @end smallexample
4233
4234 @end table
4235
4236 @cindex stopped threads
4237 @cindex threads, stopped
4238 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4239 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4240 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4241 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4242 underfoot.
4243
4244 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4245 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4246 @cindex premature return from system calls
4247 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4248 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4249 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4250 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4251 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4252 stop execution.
4253
4254 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4255 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4256 style anyways.
4257
4258 For example, do not write code like this:
4259
4260 @smallexample
4261 sleep (10);
4262 @end smallexample
4263
4264 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4265 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4266
4267 Instead, write this:
4268
4269 @smallexample
4270 int unslept = 10;
4271 while (unslept > 0)
4272 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4273 @end smallexample
4274
4275 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4276 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4277 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4278 @value{GDBN}.
4279
4280 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4281 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4282 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4283 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4284
4285 @cindex continuing threads
4286 @cindex threads, continuing
4287 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4288 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4289 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4290
4291 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4292 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4293 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4294 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4295 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4296 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4297 stops.
4298
4299 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4300 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4301 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4302 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4303
4304 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4305 thread to run.
4306
4307 @table @code
4308 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4309 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4310 @cindex lock scheduler
4311 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4312 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4313 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4314 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4315 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4316 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4317 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4318 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4319 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4320 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4321 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4322
4323 @item show scheduler-locking
4324 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4325 @end table
4326
4327
4328 @node Stack
4329 @chapter Examining the Stack
4330
4331 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4332 stopped and how it got there.
4333
4334 @cindex call stack
4335 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4336 is generated.
4337 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4338 the arguments of the call,
4339 and the local variables of the function being called.
4340 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4341 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4342 stack}.
4343
4344 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4345 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4346
4347 @cindex selected frame
4348 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4349 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4350 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4351 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4352 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4353 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4354
4355 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4356 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4357 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4358
4359 @menu
4360 * Frames:: Stack frames
4361 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4362 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4363 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4364
4365 @end menu
4366
4367 @node Frames
4368 @section Stack frames
4369
4370 @cindex frame, definition
4371 @cindex stack frame
4372 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4373 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4374 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4375 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4376 which the function is executing.
4377
4378 @cindex initial frame
4379 @cindex outermost frame
4380 @cindex innermost frame
4381 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4382 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4383 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4384 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4385 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4386 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4387 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4388 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4389
4390 @cindex frame pointer
4391 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4392 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4393 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4394 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4395 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4396 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4397
4398 @cindex frame number
4399 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4400 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4401 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4402 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4403 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4404
4405 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4406 @c underflow problems.
4407 @cindex frameless execution
4408 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4409 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4410 @smallexample
4411 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4412 @end smallexample
4413 generates functions without a frame.)
4414 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4415 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4416 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4417 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4418 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4419 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4420 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4421
4422 @table @code
4423 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4424 @cindex current stack frame
4425 @item frame @var{args}
4426 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4427 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4428 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4429 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4430
4431 @kindex select-frame
4432 @cindex selecting frame silently
4433 @item select-frame
4434 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4435 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4436 @code{frame}.
4437 @end table
4438
4439 @node Backtrace
4440 @section Backtraces
4441
4442 @cindex traceback
4443 @cindex call stack traces
4444 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4445 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4446 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4447 stack.
4448
4449 @table @code
4450 @kindex backtrace
4451 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4452 @item backtrace
4453 @itemx bt
4454 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4455 frames in the stack.
4456
4457 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4458 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
4459
4460 @item backtrace @var{n}
4461 @itemx bt @var{n}
4462 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4463
4464 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4465 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4466 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4467
4468 @item backtrace full
4469 Print the values of the local variables also.
4470 @itemx bt full
4471 @end table
4472
4473 @kindex where
4474 @kindex info stack
4475 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4476 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4477
4478 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4479 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4480 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4481 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4482 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4483 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4484 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4485 multi-threaded program.
4486
4487 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4488 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4489 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4490 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4491 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4492 line number.
4493
4494 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4495 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4496
4497 @smallexample
4498 @group
4499 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4500 at builtin.c:993
4501 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4502 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4503 at macro.c:71
4504 (More stack frames follow...)
4505 @end group
4506 @end smallexample
4507
4508 @noindent
4509 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4510 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4511 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4512
4513 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4514 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4515 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4516 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4517 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4518 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4519 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4520 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4521 such a backtrace might look like:
4522
4523 @smallexample
4524 @group
4525 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4526 at builtin.c:993
4527 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4528 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4529 at macro.c:71
4530 (More stack frames follow...)
4531 @end group
4532 @end smallexample
4533
4534 @noindent
4535 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4536 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4537
4538 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4539 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4540 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4541
4542 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4543 @cindex program entry point
4544 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4545 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4546 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4547 @code{main}@footnote{
4548 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4549 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4550 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4551 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4552 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4553 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4554
4555 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4556 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4557
4558 @table @code
4559 @item set backtrace past-main
4560 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4561 @kindex set backtrace
4562 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4563
4564 @item set backtrace past-main off
4565 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4566 default.
4567
4568 @item show backtrace past-main
4569 @kindex show backtrace
4570 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4571
4572 @item set backtrace past-entry
4573 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4574 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4575 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4576 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4577
4578 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4579 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4580 application. This is the default.
4581
4582 @item show backtrace past-entry
4583 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4584
4585 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4586 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4587 @cindex backtrace limit
4588 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4589 unlimited.
4590
4591 @item show backtrace limit
4592 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4593 @end table
4594
4595 @node Selection
4596 @section Selecting a frame
4597
4598 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4599 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4600 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4601 of the stack frame just selected.
4602
4603 @table @code
4604 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4605 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4606 @item frame @var{n}
4607 @itemx f @var{n}
4608 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4609 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4610 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4611 @code{main}.
4612
4613 @item frame @var{addr}
4614 @itemx f @var{addr}
4615 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4616 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4617 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4618 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4619 switches between them.
4620
4621 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4622 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4623
4624 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4625 pointer and a program counter.
4626
4627 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4628 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4629
4630 @kindex up
4631 @item up @var{n}
4632 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4633 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4634 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4635
4636 @kindex down
4637 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4638 @item down @var{n}
4639 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4640 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4641 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4642 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4643 @end table
4644
4645 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4646 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4647 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4648 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4649
4650 @need 1000
4651 For example:
4652
4653 @smallexample
4654 @group
4655 (@value{GDBP}) up
4656 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4657 at env.c:10
4658 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4659 @end group
4660 @end smallexample
4661
4662 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4663 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4664 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4665 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4666 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4667 for details.
4668
4669 @table @code
4670 @kindex down-silently
4671 @kindex up-silently
4672 @item up-silently @var{n}
4673 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4674 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4675 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4676 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4677 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4678 distracting.
4679 @end table
4680
4681 @node Frame Info
4682 @section Information about a frame
4683
4684 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4685 stack frame.
4686
4687 @table @code
4688 @item frame
4689 @itemx f
4690 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4691 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4692 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4693 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4694 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4695
4696 @kindex info frame
4697 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4698 @item info frame
4699 @itemx info f
4700 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4701 including:
4702
4703 @itemize @bullet
4704 @item
4705 the address of the frame
4706 @item
4707 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4708 @item
4709 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4710 @item
4711 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4712 @item
4713 the address of the frame's arguments
4714 @item
4715 the address of the frame's local variables
4716 @item
4717 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4718 @item
4719 which registers were saved in the frame
4720 @end itemize
4721
4722 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4723 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4724 the usual conventions.
4725
4726 @item info frame @var{addr}
4727 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4728 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4729 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4730 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4731 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4732 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4733
4734 @kindex info args
4735 @item info args
4736 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4737
4738 @item info locals
4739 @kindex info locals
4740 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4741 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4742 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4743
4744 @kindex info catch
4745 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4746 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4747 @item info catch
4748 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4749 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4750 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4751 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4752 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4753
4754 @end table
4755
4756
4757 @node Source
4758 @chapter Examining Source Files
4759
4760 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4761 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4762 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4763 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4764 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4765 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4766 source files by explicit command.
4767
4768 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4769 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4770 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4771
4772 @menu
4773 * List:: Printing source lines
4774 * Edit:: Editing source files
4775 * Search:: Searching source files
4776 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4777 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4778 @end menu
4779
4780 @node List
4781 @section Printing source lines
4782
4783 @kindex list
4784 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4785 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4786 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4787 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4788
4789 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4790
4791 @table @code
4792 @item list @var{linenum}
4793 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4794 current source file.
4795
4796 @item list @var{function}
4797 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4798 @var{function}.
4799
4800 @item list
4801 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4802 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4803 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4804 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4805 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4806
4807 @item list -
4808 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4809 @end table
4810
4811 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4812 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4813 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4814
4815 @table @code
4816 @kindex set listsize
4817 @item set listsize @var{count}
4818 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4819 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4820
4821 @kindex show listsize
4822 @item show listsize
4823 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4824 @end table
4825
4826 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4827 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4828 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4829 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4830 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4831
4832 @cindex linespec
4833 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4834 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4835 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4836 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4837
4838 @table @code
4839 @item list @var{linespec}
4840 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4841
4842 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4843 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4844 linespecs.
4845
4846 @item list ,@var{last}
4847 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4848
4849 @item list @var{first},
4850 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4851
4852 @item list +
4853 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4854
4855 @item list -
4856 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4857
4858 @item list
4859 As described in the preceding table.
4860 @end table
4861
4862 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4863 kinds of linespec.
4864
4865 @table @code
4866 @item @var{number}
4867 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4868 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4869 the same source file as the first linespec.
4870
4871 @item +@var{offset}
4872 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4873 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4874 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4875 first linespec.
4876
4877 @item -@var{offset}
4878 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4879
4880 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4881 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4882
4883 @item @var{function}
4884 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4885 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4886
4887 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4888 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4889 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4890 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4891 identically named functions in different source files.
4892
4893 @item *@var{address}
4894 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4895 @var{address} may be any expression.
4896 @end table
4897
4898 @node Edit
4899 @section Editing source files
4900 @cindex editing source files
4901
4902 @kindex edit
4903 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4904 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4905 The editing program of your choice
4906 is invoked with the current line set to
4907 the active line in the program.
4908 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4909 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4910
4911 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4912
4913 @table @code
4914 @item edit
4915 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4916
4917 @item edit @var{number}
4918 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4919
4920 @item edit @var{function}
4921 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4922
4923 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4924 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4925
4926 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4927 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4928 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4929 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4930 identically named functions in different source files.
4931
4932 @item edit *@var{address}
4933 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4934 @var{address} may be any expression.
4935 @end table
4936
4937 @subsection Choosing your editor
4938 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4939 @footnote{
4940 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4941 following command-line syntax:
4942 @smallexample
4943 ex +@var{number} file
4944 @end smallexample
4945 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
4946 the file where to start editing.}.
4947 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
4948 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4949 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4950 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4951 @smallexample
4952 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4953 export EDITOR
4954 gdb @dots{}
4955 @end smallexample
4956 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4957 @smallexample
4958 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4959 gdb @dots{}
4960 @end smallexample
4961
4962 @node Search
4963 @section Searching source files
4964 @cindex searching source files
4965
4966 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4967 regular expression.
4968
4969 @table @code
4970 @kindex search
4971 @kindex forward-search
4972 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4973 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4974 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4975 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4976 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4977 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4978 @code{fo}.
4979
4980 @kindex reverse-search
4981 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4982 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4983 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4984 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4985 this command as @code{rev}.
4986 @end table
4987
4988 @node Source Path
4989 @section Specifying source directories
4990
4991 @cindex source path
4992 @cindex directories for source files
4993 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4994 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4995 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4996 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4997 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4998 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4999 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5000
5001 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5002 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5003 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5004 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5005 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5006 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5007 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5008 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5009 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5010 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5011 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5012
5013 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5014 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5015 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5016 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5017 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5018 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5019
5020 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5021 source files.
5022
5023 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5024 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5025 each line is in the file.
5026
5027 @kindex directory
5028 @kindex dir
5029 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5030 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5031 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5032
5033 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5034 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5035
5036 @table @code
5037 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5038 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5039 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5040 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5041 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5042 part of absolute file names) or
5043 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5044 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5045
5046 @kindex cdir
5047 @kindex cwd
5048 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5049 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
5050 @cindex compilation directory
5051 @cindex current directory
5052 @cindex working directory
5053 @cindex directory, current
5054 @cindex directory, compilation
5055 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5056 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5057 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5058 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5059 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5060 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5061
5062 @item directory
5063 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5064
5065 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5066 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5067
5068 @item show directories
5069 @kindex show directories
5070 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5071 @end table
5072
5073 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5074 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5075 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5076
5077 @enumerate
5078 @item
5079 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5080
5081 @item
5082 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5083 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5084 directories in one command.
5085 @end enumerate
5086
5087 @node Machine Code
5088 @section Source and machine code
5089 @cindex source line and its code address
5090
5091 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5092 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5093 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5094 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5095 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5096 well as hex.
5097
5098 @table @code
5099 @kindex info line
5100 @item info line @var{linespec}
5101 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5102 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5103 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5104 source lines}).
5105 @end table
5106
5107 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5108 the object code for the first line of function
5109 @code{m4_changequote}:
5110
5111 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5112 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5113 @smallexample
5114 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5115 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5116 @end smallexample
5117
5118 @noindent
5119 @cindex code address and its source line
5120 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5121 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5122 @smallexample
5123 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5124 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5125 @end smallexample
5126
5127 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5128 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5129 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5130 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5131 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5132 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5133 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5134 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5135 variables}).
5136
5137 @table @code
5138 @kindex disassemble
5139 @cindex assembly instructions
5140 @cindex instructions, assembly
5141 @cindex machine instructions
5142 @cindex listing machine instructions
5143 @item disassemble
5144 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5145 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5146 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5147 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5148 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5149 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5150 @end table
5151
5152 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5153 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5154
5155 @smallexample
5156 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5157 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5158 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5159 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5160 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5161 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5162 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5163 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5164 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5165 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5166 End of assembler dump.
5167 @end smallexample
5168
5169 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5170 mnemonics or other syntax.
5171
5172 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5173 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5174 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5175 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5176 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5177
5178 @table @code
5179 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5180 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5181 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5182 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5183 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5184 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5185
5186 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5187 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5188 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5189 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5190
5191 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5192 @item show disassembly-flavor
5193 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5194 @end table
5195
5196
5197 @node Data
5198 @chapter Examining Data
5199
5200 @cindex printing data
5201 @cindex examining data
5202 @kindex print
5203 @kindex inspect
5204 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5205 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5206 @c different window or something like that.
5207 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5208 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5209 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5210 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5211 Different Languages}).
5212
5213 @table @code
5214 @item print @var{expr}
5215 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5216 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5217 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5218 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5219 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5220 formats}.
5221
5222 @item print
5223 @itemx print /@var{f}
5224 @cindex reprint the last value
5225 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5226 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5227 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5228 @end table
5229
5230 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5231 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5232 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5233
5234 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5235 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5236 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5237 Table}.
5238
5239 @menu
5240 * Expressions:: Expressions
5241 * Variables:: Program variables
5242 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5243 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5244 * Memory:: Examining memory
5245 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5246 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5247 * Value History:: Value history
5248 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5249 * Registers:: Registers
5250 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5251 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5252 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5253 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5254 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5255 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5256 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5257 character set than GDB does
5258 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5259 @end menu
5260
5261 @node Expressions
5262 @section Expressions
5263
5264 @cindex expressions
5265 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5266 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5267 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5268 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5269 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5270 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5271 @ref{Compilation}.
5272
5273 @cindex arrays in expressions
5274 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5275 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5276 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5277 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5278
5279 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5280 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5281 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5282 languages.
5283
5284 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5285 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5286
5287 @cindex casts, in expressions
5288 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5289 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5290 at that address in memory.
5291 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5292
5293 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5294 to programming languages:
5295
5296 @table @code
5297 @item @@
5298 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5299 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5300
5301 @item ::
5302 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5303 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5304
5305 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5306 @cindex type casting memory
5307 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5308 @cindex casts, to view memory
5309 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5310 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5311 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5312 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5313 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5314 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5315 @end table
5316
5317 @node Variables
5318 @section Program variables
5319
5320 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5321 in your program.
5322
5323 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5324 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5325
5326 @itemize @bullet
5327 @item
5328 global (or file-static)
5329 @end itemize
5330
5331 @noindent or
5332
5333 @itemize @bullet
5334 @item
5335 visible according to the scope rules of the
5336 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5337 @end itemize
5338
5339 @noindent This means that in the function
5340
5341 @smallexample
5342 foo (a)
5343 int a;
5344 @{
5345 bar (a);
5346 @{
5347 int b = test ();
5348 bar (b);
5349 @}
5350 @}
5351 @end smallexample
5352
5353 @noindent
5354 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5355 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5356 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5357 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5358
5359 @cindex variable name conflict
5360 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5361 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5362 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5363 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5364 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5365 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5366 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5367
5368 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5369 @iftex
5370 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5371 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5372 @end iftex
5373 @smallexample
5374 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5375 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5376 @end smallexample
5377
5378 @noindent
5379 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5380 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5381 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5382 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5383
5384 @smallexample
5385 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5386 @end smallexample
5387
5388 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5389 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5390 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5391 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5392 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5393 @c conflict?? --mew
5394
5395 @cindex wrong values
5396 @cindex variable values, wrong
5397 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5398 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5399 @quotation
5400 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5401 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5402 scope, and just before exit.
5403 @end quotation
5404 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5405 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5406 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5407 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5408 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5409 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5410 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5411 variable definitions may be gone.
5412
5413 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5414 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5415 when compiling.
5416
5417 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5418 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5419 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5420 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5421 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5422 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5423 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5424
5425 @smallexample
5426 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5427 @end smallexample
5428
5429 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5430 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5431 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5432 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5433 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5434 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5435 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5436 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5437 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5438 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5439
5440 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5441 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5442 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5443 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5444
5445 @node Arrays
5446 @section Artificial arrays
5447
5448 @cindex artificial array
5449 @cindex arrays
5450 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5451 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5452 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5453 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5454 program.
5455
5456 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5457 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5458 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5459 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5460 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5461 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5462 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5463 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5464 example. If a program says
5465
5466 @smallexample
5467 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5468 @end smallexample
5469
5470 @noindent
5471 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5472
5473 @smallexample
5474 p *array@@len
5475 @end smallexample
5476
5477 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5478 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5479 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5480 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5481 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5482
5483 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5484 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5485 The value need not be in memory:
5486 @smallexample
5487 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5488 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5489 @end smallexample
5490
5491 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5492 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5493 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5494 @smallexample
5495 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5496 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5497 @end smallexample
5498
5499 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5500 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5501 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5502 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5503 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5504 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5505 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5506 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5507 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5508 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5509
5510 @smallexample
5511 set $i = 0
5512 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5513 @key{RET}
5514 @key{RET}
5515 @dots{}
5516 @end smallexample
5517
5518 @node Output Formats
5519 @section Output formats
5520
5521 @cindex formatted output
5522 @cindex output formats
5523 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5524 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5525 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5526 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5527 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5528
5529 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5530 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5531 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5532 letters supported are:
5533
5534 @table @code
5535 @item x
5536 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5537 hexadecimal.
5538
5539 @item d
5540 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5541
5542 @item u
5543 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5544
5545 @item o
5546 Print as integer in octal.
5547
5548 @item t
5549 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5550 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5551 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5552 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5553
5554 @item a
5555 @cindex unknown address, locating
5556 @cindex locate address
5557 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5558 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5559 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5560
5561 @smallexample
5562 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5563 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5564 @end smallexample
5565
5566 @noindent
5567 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5568 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5569
5570 @item c
5571 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5572 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5573 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5574 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5575
5576 @item f
5577 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5578 using typical floating point syntax.
5579 @end table
5580
5581 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5582
5583 @smallexample
5584 p/x $pc
5585 @end smallexample
5586
5587 @noindent
5588 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5589 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5590
5591 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5592 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5593 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5594
5595 @node Memory
5596 @section Examining memory
5597
5598 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5599 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5600
5601 @cindex examining memory
5602 @table @code
5603 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5604 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5605 @itemx x @var{addr}
5606 @itemx x
5607 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5608 @end table
5609
5610 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5611 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5612 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5613 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5614 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5615
5616 @table @r
5617 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5618 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5619 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5620 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5621 @c 4.1.2.
5622
5623 @item @var{f}, the display format
5624 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5625 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5626 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5627 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5628 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5629 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5630
5631 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5632 The unit size is any of
5633
5634 @table @code
5635 @item b
5636 Bytes.
5637 @item h
5638 Halfwords (two bytes).
5639 @item w
5640 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5641 @item g
5642 Giant words (eight bytes).
5643 @end table
5644
5645 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5646 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5647 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5648
5649 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5650 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5651 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5652 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5653 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5654 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5655 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5656 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5657 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5658 a value from memory).
5659 @end table
5660
5661 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5662 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5663 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5664 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5665 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5666
5667 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5668 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5669 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5670 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5671 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5672
5673 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5674 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5675 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5676 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5677 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5678 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5679
5680 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5681 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5682 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5683 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5684 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5685 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5686 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5687
5688 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5689 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5690 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5691 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5692 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5693 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5694 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5695 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5696 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5697
5698 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5699 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5700 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5701
5702 @cindex remote memory comparison
5703 @cindex verify remote memory image
5704 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5705 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5706 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5707 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5708 situations.
5709
5710 @table @code
5711 @kindex compare-sections
5712 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5713 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5714 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5715 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5716 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5717 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5718 remote request.
5719 @end table
5720
5721 @node Auto Display
5722 @section Automatic display
5723 @cindex automatic display
5724 @cindex display of expressions
5725
5726 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5727 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5728 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5729 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5730 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5731 The automatic display looks like this:
5732
5733 @smallexample
5734 2: foo = 38
5735 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5736 @end smallexample
5737
5738 @noindent
5739 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5740 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5741 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5742 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5743 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5744 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5745 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5746
5747 @table @code
5748 @kindex display
5749 @item display @var{expr}
5750 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5751 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5752
5753 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5754
5755 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5756 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5757 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5758 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5759 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5760
5761 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5762 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5763 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5764 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5765 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5766 @end table
5767
5768 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5769 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5770 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5771
5772 @table @code
5773 @kindex delete display
5774 @kindex undisplay
5775 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5776 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5777 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5778
5779 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5780 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5781
5782 @kindex disable display
5783 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5784 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5785 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5786 enabled again later.
5787
5788 @kindex enable display
5789 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5790 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5791 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5792
5793 @item display
5794 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5795 done when your program stops.
5796
5797 @kindex info display
5798 @item info display
5799 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5800 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5801 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5802 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5803 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5804 @end table
5805
5806 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5807 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5808 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5809 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5810 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5811 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5812 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5813 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5814 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5815 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5816 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5817
5818 @node Print Settings
5819 @section Print settings
5820
5821 @cindex format options
5822 @cindex print settings
5823 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5824 and symbols are printed.
5825
5826 @noindent
5827 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5828
5829 @table @code
5830 @kindex set print
5831 @item set print address
5832 @itemx set print address on
5833 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
5834 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5835 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5836 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5837 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5838 @code{set print address on}:
5839
5840 @smallexample
5841 @group
5842 (@value{GDBP}) f
5843 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5844 at input.c:530
5845 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5846 @end group
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 @item set print address off
5850 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5851 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5852
5853 @smallexample
5854 @group
5855 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5856 (@value{GDBP}) f
5857 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5858 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5859 @end group
5860 @end smallexample
5861
5862 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5863 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5864 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5865 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5866
5867 @kindex show print
5868 @item show print address
5869 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5870 @end table
5871
5872 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5873 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5874 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5875 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5876 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5877 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5878 it prints a symbolic address:
5879
5880 @table @code
5881 @item set print symbol-filename on
5882 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
5883 @cindex symbol, source file and line
5884 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5885 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5886
5887 @item set print symbol-filename off
5888 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5889 default.
5890
5891 @item show print symbol-filename
5892 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5893 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5894 @end table
5895
5896 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5897 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5898 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5899
5900 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5901 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5902
5903 @table @code
5904 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5905 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
5906 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5907 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5908 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5909 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5910
5911 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5912 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5913 symbolic address.
5914 @end table
5915
5916 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5917 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5918 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5919 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5920 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5921 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5922 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5923 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5924
5925 @smallexample
5926 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5927 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5928 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5929 @end smallexample
5930
5931 @quotation
5932 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5933 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5934 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5935 @end quotation
5936
5937 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5938
5939 @table @code
5940 @item set print array
5941 @itemx set print array on
5942 @cindex pretty print arrays
5943 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5944 but uses more space. The default is off.
5945
5946 @item set print array off
5947 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5948
5949 @item show print array
5950 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5951 arrays.
5952
5953 @cindex print array indexes
5954 @item set print array-indexes
5955 @itemx set print array-indexes on
5956 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
5957 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
5958 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
5959
5960 @item set print array-indexes off
5961 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
5962
5963 @item show print array-indexes
5964 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
5965 arrays.
5966
5967 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5968 @cindex number of array elements to print
5969 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
5970 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5971 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5972 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5973 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5974 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5975 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5976
5977 @item show print elements
5978 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5979 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5980
5981 @item set print repeats
5982 @cindex repeated array elements
5983 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
5984 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
5985 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
5986 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
5987 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
5988 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
5989 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
5990
5991 @item show print repeats
5992 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
5993 elements.
5994
5995 @item set print null-stop
5996 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
5997 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5998 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5999 contain only short strings.
6000 The default is off.
6001
6002 @item show print null-stop
6003 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6004 @sc{null} character.
6005
6006 @item set print pretty on
6007 @cindex print structures in indented form
6008 @cindex indentation in structure display
6009 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6010 per line, like this:
6011
6012 @smallexample
6013 @group
6014 $1 = @{
6015 next = 0x0,
6016 flags = @{
6017 sweet = 1,
6018 sour = 1
6019 @},
6020 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6021 @}
6022 @end group
6023 @end smallexample
6024
6025 @item set print pretty off
6026 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6027
6028 @smallexample
6029 @group
6030 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6031 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6032 @end group
6033 @end smallexample
6034
6035 @noindent
6036 This is the default format.
6037
6038 @item show print pretty
6039 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6040
6041 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6042 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6043 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6044 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6045 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6046 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6047 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6048 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6049
6050 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6051 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6052 international character sets, and is the default.
6053
6054 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6055 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6056
6057 @item set print union on
6058 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6059 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6060 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6061
6062 @item set print union off
6063 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6064 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6065 instead.
6066
6067 @item show print union
6068 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6069 structures and other unions.
6070
6071 For example, given the declarations
6072
6073 @smallexample
6074 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6075 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6076 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6077 Bug_forms;
6078
6079 struct thing @{
6080 Species it;
6081 union @{
6082 Tree_forms tree;
6083 Bug_forms bug;
6084 @} form;
6085 @};
6086
6087 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 @noindent
6091 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6092
6093 @smallexample
6094 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6095 @end smallexample
6096
6097 @noindent
6098 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6099
6100 @smallexample
6101 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6102 @end smallexample
6103
6104 @noindent
6105 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6106 and in Pascal.
6107 @end table
6108
6109 @need 1000
6110 @noindent
6111 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6112
6113 @table @code
6114 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6115 @item set print demangle
6116 @itemx set print demangle on
6117 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6118 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6119 linkage. The default is on.
6120
6121 @item show print demangle
6122 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6123
6124 @item set print asm-demangle
6125 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6126 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6127 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6128 The default is off.
6129
6130 @item show print asm-demangle
6131 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6132 or demangled form.
6133
6134 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6135 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6136 @kindex set demangle-style
6137 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6138 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6139 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6140
6141 @table @code
6142 @item auto
6143 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6144
6145 @item gnu
6146 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6147 This is the default.
6148
6149 @item hp
6150 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6151
6152 @item lucid
6153 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6154
6155 @item arm
6156 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6157 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6158 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6159 require further enhancement to permit that.
6160
6161 @end table
6162 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6163
6164 @item show demangle-style
6165 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6166
6167 @item set print object
6168 @itemx set print object on
6169 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6170 @cindex display derived types
6171 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6172 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6173 the virtual function table.
6174
6175 @item set print object off
6176 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6177 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6178
6179 @item show print object
6180 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6181
6182 @item set print static-members
6183 @itemx set print static-members on
6184 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6185 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6186
6187 @item set print static-members off
6188 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6189
6190 @item show print static-members
6191 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6192
6193 @item set print pascal_static-members
6194 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6195 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
6196 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
6197 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6198
6199 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6200 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6201
6202 @item show print pascal_static-members
6203 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6204
6205 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6206 @item set print vtbl
6207 @itemx set print vtbl on
6208 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6209 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6210 @cindex VTBL display
6211 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6212 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6213 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6214
6215 @item set print vtbl off
6216 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6217
6218 @item show print vtbl
6219 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6220 @end table
6221
6222 @node Value History
6223 @section Value history
6224
6225 @cindex value history
6226 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6227 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6228 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6229 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6230 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6231 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6232 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6233 symbol table.
6234
6235 @cindex @code{$}
6236 @cindex @code{$$}
6237 @cindex history number
6238 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6239 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6240 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6241 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6242 history number.
6243
6244 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6245 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6246 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6247 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6248 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6249 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6250 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6251
6252 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6253 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6254
6255 @smallexample
6256 p *$
6257 @end smallexample
6258
6259 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6260 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6261
6262 @smallexample
6263 p *$.next
6264 @end smallexample
6265
6266 @noindent
6267 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6268 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6269
6270 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6271 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6272
6273 @smallexample
6274 print x
6275 set x=5
6276 @end smallexample
6277
6278 @noindent
6279 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6280 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6281
6282 @table @code
6283 @kindex show values
6284 @item show values
6285 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6286 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6287 values} does not change the history.
6288
6289 @item show values @var{n}
6290 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6291
6292 @item show values +
6293 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6294 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6295 @end table
6296
6297 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6298 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6299
6300 @node Convenience Vars
6301 @section Convenience variables
6302
6303 @cindex convenience variables
6304 @cindex user-defined variables
6305 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6306 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6307 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6308 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6309 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6310
6311 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6312 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6313 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6314 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6315 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6316
6317 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6318 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6319 For example:
6320
6321 @smallexample
6322 set $foo = *object_ptr
6323 @end smallexample
6324
6325 @noindent
6326 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6327 @code{object_ptr}.
6328
6329 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6330 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6331 value with another assignment at any time.
6332
6333 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6334 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6335 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6336 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6337
6338 @table @code
6339 @kindex show convenience
6340 @cindex show all user variables
6341 @item show convenience
6342 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6343 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6344
6345 @kindex init-if-undefined
6346 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6347 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6348 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6349 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6350 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6351 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6352 override default values used in a command script.
6353
6354 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6355 any side-effects do not occur.
6356 @end table
6357
6358 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6359 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6360 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6361
6362 @smallexample
6363 set $i = 0
6364 print bar[$i++]->contents
6365 @end smallexample
6366
6367 @noindent
6368 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6369
6370 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6371 values likely to be useful.
6372
6373 @table @code
6374 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6375 @item $_
6376 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6377 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6378 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6379 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6380 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6381 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6382 to the type of @code{$__}.
6383
6384 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6385 @item $__
6386 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6387 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6388 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6389
6390 @item $_exitcode
6391 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6392 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6393 the program being debugged terminates.
6394 @end table
6395
6396 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6397 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6398 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6399
6400 @node Registers
6401 @section Registers
6402
6403 @cindex registers
6404 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6405 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6406 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6407 your machine.
6408
6409 @table @code
6410 @kindex info registers
6411 @item info registers
6412 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6413 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6414
6415 @kindex info all-registers
6416 @cindex floating point registers
6417 @item info all-registers
6418 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6419 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6420
6421 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6422 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6423 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6424 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6425 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6426 @end table
6427
6428 @cindex stack pointer register
6429 @cindex program counter register
6430 @cindex process status register
6431 @cindex frame pointer register
6432 @cindex standard registers
6433 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6434 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6435 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6436 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6437 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6438 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6439 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6440 you could print the program counter in hex with
6441
6442 @smallexample
6443 p/x $pc
6444 @end smallexample
6445
6446 @noindent
6447 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6448
6449 @smallexample
6450 x/i $pc
6451 @end smallexample
6452
6453 @noindent
6454 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6455 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6456 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6457 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6458 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6459 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6460 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6461
6462 @smallexample
6463 set $sp += 4
6464 @end smallexample
6465
6466 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6467 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6468 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6469 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6470 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6471 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6472 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6473
6474 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6475 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6476 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6477 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6478 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6479 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6480 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6481
6482 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6483 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6484 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6485 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6486 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6487 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6488 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6489 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6490 prints the data in both formats.
6491
6492 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6493 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6494 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6495 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6496 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6497 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6498 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6499
6500 @smallexample
6501 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6502 $1 = @{
6503 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6504 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6505 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6506 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6507 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6508 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6509 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6510 @}
6511 @end smallexample
6512
6513 @noindent
6514 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6515 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6516 value to a @code{struct} member:
6517
6518 @smallexample
6519 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6520 @end smallexample
6521
6522 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6523 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6524 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6525 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6526 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6527 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6528
6529 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6530 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6531 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6532 frame makes no difference.
6533
6534 @node Floating Point Hardware
6535 @section Floating point hardware
6536 @cindex floating point
6537
6538 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6539 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6540
6541 @table @code
6542 @kindex info float
6543 @item info float
6544 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6545 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6546 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6547 the ARM and x86 machines.
6548 @end table
6549
6550 @node Vector Unit
6551 @section Vector Unit
6552 @cindex vector unit
6553
6554 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6555 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6556
6557 @table @code
6558 @kindex info vector
6559 @item info vector
6560 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6561 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6562 @end table
6563
6564 @node OS Information
6565 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6566 @cindex OS information
6567
6568 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6569 you debug your program.
6570
6571 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6572 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6573 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6574 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6575 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6576 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6577 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6578 structure.
6579
6580 @table @code
6581 @item info udot
6582 @kindex info udot
6583 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6584 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6585 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6586 the @code{examine} command.
6587 @end table
6588
6589 @cindex auxiliary vector
6590 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6591 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6592 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6593 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6594 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6595 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6596 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6597 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6598 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6599 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6600 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see @ref{Remote
6601 configuration, auxiliary vector}.
6602
6603 @table @code
6604 @kindex info auxv
6605 @item info auxv
6606 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6607 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6608 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6609 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6610 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6611 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6612 an unrecognized tag.
6613 @end table
6614
6615
6616 @node Memory Region Attributes
6617 @section Memory region attributes
6618 @cindex memory region attributes
6619
6620 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6621 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
6622 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
6623 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
6624
6625 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6626 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6627 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6628 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6629 all memory.
6630
6631 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6632 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6633
6634 @table @code
6635 @kindex mem
6636 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6637 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6638 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6639 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6640 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6641 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6642
6643 @kindex delete mem
6644 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6645 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6646 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6647
6648 @kindex disable mem
6649 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6650 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6651 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6652 It may be enabled again later.
6653
6654 @kindex enable mem
6655 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6656 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6657
6658 @kindex info mem
6659 @item info mem
6660 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6661 for each region:
6662
6663 @table @emph
6664 @item Memory Region Number
6665 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6666 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6667 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6668
6669 @item Lo Address
6670 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6671
6672 @item Hi Address
6673 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6674
6675 @item Attributes
6676 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6677 @end table
6678 @end table
6679
6680
6681 @subsection Attributes
6682
6683 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6684 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6685 write accesses to a memory region.
6686
6687 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6688 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6689 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6690
6691 @table @code
6692 @item ro
6693 Memory is read only.
6694 @item wo
6695 Memory is write only.
6696 @item rw
6697 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6698 @end table
6699
6700 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6701 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6702 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6703 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6704 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6705
6706 @table @code
6707 @item 8
6708 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6709 @item 16
6710 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6711 @item 32
6712 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6713 @item 64
6714 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6715 @end table
6716
6717 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6718 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6719 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6720 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6721 @c
6722 @c @table @code
6723 @c @item hwbreak
6724 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6725 @c @item swbreak (default)
6726 @c @end table
6727
6728 @subsubsection Data Cache
6729 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6730 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6731 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6732 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6733 registers.
6734
6735 @table @code
6736 @item cache
6737 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6738 @item nocache
6739 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6740 @end table
6741
6742 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6743 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6744 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6745 @c
6746 @c @table @code
6747 @c @item verify
6748 @c @item noverify (default)
6749 @c @end table
6750
6751 @node Dump/Restore Files
6752 @section Copy between memory and a file
6753 @cindex dump/restore files
6754 @cindex append data to a file
6755 @cindex dump data to a file
6756 @cindex restore data from a file
6757
6758 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6759 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6760 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6761 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6762 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6763 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6764 files.
6765
6766 @table @code
6767
6768 @kindex dump
6769 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6770 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6771 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6772 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6773
6774 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6775 @table @code
6776 @item binary
6777 Raw binary form.
6778 @item ihex
6779 Intel hex format.
6780 @item srec
6781 Motorola S-record format.
6782 @item tekhex
6783 Tektronix Hex format.
6784 @end table
6785
6786 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6787 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6788 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6789 form.
6790
6791 @kindex append
6792 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6793 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6794 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6795 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6796 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6797
6798 @kindex restore
6799 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6800 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6801 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6802 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6803 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6804
6805 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6806 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6807 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6808 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6809 from that location.
6810
6811 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6812 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6813 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6814 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6815
6816 @end table
6817
6818 @node Core File Generation
6819 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
6820 @cindex dump core from inferior
6821
6822 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
6823 image of a running process and its process status (register values
6824 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
6825 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
6826 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
6827 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
6828 the post-mortem debugging mode.
6829
6830 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
6831 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
6832 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
6833
6834 @table @code
6835 @kindex gcore
6836 @kindex generate-core-file
6837 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
6838 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
6839 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
6840 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
6841 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
6842 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
6843
6844 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
6845 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
6846 @end table
6847
6848 @node Character Sets
6849 @section Character Sets
6850 @cindex character sets
6851 @cindex charset
6852 @cindex translating between character sets
6853 @cindex host character set
6854 @cindex target character set
6855
6856 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
6857 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
6858 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
6859 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
6860 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
6861 @dfn{target character set}.
6862
6863 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
6864 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
6865 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
6866 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
6867 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
6868 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
6869 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
6870 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
6871 character and string literals in expressions.
6872
6873 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
6874 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
6875 target-charset} command, described below.
6876
6877 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
6878 support:
6879
6880 @table @code
6881 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
6882 @kindex set target-charset
6883 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
6884 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
6885 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6886 list the target character sets it supports.
6887 @end table
6888
6889 @table @code
6890 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
6891 @kindex set host-charset
6892 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6893
6894 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6895 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6896 @code{set host-charset} command.
6897
6898 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6899 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
6900 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6901 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6902 list the host character sets it supports.
6903
6904 @item set charset @var{charset}
6905 @kindex set charset
6906 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6907 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6908 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6909 for both host and target.
6910
6911
6912 @item show charset
6913 @kindex show charset
6914 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6915
6916 @itemx show host-charset
6917 @kindex show host-charset
6918 Show the name of the current host charset.
6919
6920 @itemx show target-charset
6921 @kindex show target-charset
6922 Show the name of the current target charset.
6923
6924 @end table
6925
6926 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6927 sets:
6928
6929 @table @code
6930
6931 @item ASCII
6932 @cindex ASCII character set
6933 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6934 character set.
6935
6936 @item ISO-8859-1
6937 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6938 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6939 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
6940 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6941 this as its host character set.
6942
6943 @item EBCDIC-US
6944 @itemx IBM1047
6945 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6946 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6947 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6948 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6949 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6950
6951 @end table
6952
6953 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6954 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6955 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6956
6957 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6958 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6959 @file{charset-test.c}:
6960
6961 @smallexample
6962 #include <stdio.h>
6963
6964 char ascii_hello[]
6965 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6966 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6967 char ibm1047_hello[]
6968 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6969 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6970
6971 main ()
6972 @{
6973 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6974 @}
6975 @end smallexample
6976
6977 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6978 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6979 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6980
6981 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6982
6983 @smallexample
6984 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6985 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6986 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6987 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6988 @dots{}
6989 (@value{GDBP})
6990 @end smallexample
6991
6992 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6993 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6994 strings:
6995
6996 @smallexample
6997 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
6998 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
6999 (@value{GDBP})
7000 @end smallexample
7001
7002 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7003 initial character set:
7004 @smallexample
7005 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7006 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7007 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7008 (@value{GDBP})
7009 @end smallexample
7010
7011 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7012 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7013 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7014 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7015 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7016
7017 @smallexample
7018 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7019 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7020 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7021 $2 = 72 'H'
7022 (@value{GDBP})
7023 @end smallexample
7024
7025 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7026 literals you use in expressions:
7027
7028 @smallexample
7029 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7030 $3 = 43 '+'
7031 (@value{GDBP})
7032 @end smallexample
7033
7034 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7035 character.
7036
7037 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7038 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7039 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7040
7041 @smallexample
7042 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7043 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7044 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7045 $5 = 200 '\310'
7046 (@value{GDBP})
7047 @end smallexample
7048
7049 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7050 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7051
7052 @smallexample
7053 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7054 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7055 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7056 @end smallexample
7057
7058 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7059 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7060 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7061 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7062 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7063
7064 @smallexample
7065 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7066 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7067 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7068 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7069 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7070 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7071 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7072 $7 = 72 '\110'
7073 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7074 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7075 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7076 $9 = 200 'H'
7077 (@value{GDBP})
7078 @end smallexample
7079
7080 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7081 string literals you use in expressions:
7082
7083 @smallexample
7084 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7085 $10 = 78 '+'
7086 (@value{GDBP})
7087 @end smallexample
7088
7089 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7090 character.
7091
7092 @node Caching Remote Data
7093 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7094 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7095
7096 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7097 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7098 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7099 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7100 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7101 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7102 volatile registers are in use.
7103
7104 @table @code
7105 @kindex set remotecache
7106 @item set remotecache on
7107 @itemx set remotecache off
7108 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7109 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7110
7111 @kindex show remotecache
7112 @item show remotecache
7113 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7114
7115 @kindex info dcache
7116 @item info dcache
7117 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7118 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7119 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7120 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7121 the data cache operation.
7122 @end table
7123
7124
7125 @node Macros
7126 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7127
7128 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7129 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7130 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7131 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7132 where it was defined.
7133
7134 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7135 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7136 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7137 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7138
7139 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7140 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7141 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7142 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7143 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7144 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7145 see @ref{List}.
7146
7147 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7148 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7149 variable-arity macros.
7150
7151 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7152 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7153 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7154
7155 @table @code
7156
7157 @kindex macro expand
7158 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7159 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7160 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7161 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7162 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7163 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7164 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7165 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7166 it can be any string of tokens.
7167
7168 @kindex macro exp1
7169 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7170 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7171 @cindex expand macro once
7172 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7173 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7174 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7175 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7176 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7177 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7178 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7179 can be any string of tokens.
7180
7181 @kindex info macro
7182 @cindex macro definition, showing
7183 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7184 @item info macro @var{macro}
7185 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7186 source location where that definition was established.
7187
7188 @kindex macro define
7189 @cindex user-defined macros
7190 @cindex defining macros interactively
7191 @cindex macros, user-defined
7192 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7193 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7194 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7195 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7196 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7197 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7198 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7199 given in @var{arglist}.
7200
7201 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7202 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7203 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7204 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7205 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7206
7207 @kindex macro undef
7208 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7209 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7210 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7211 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7212 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7213 debugged.
7214
7215 @kindex macro list
7216 @item macro list
7217 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7218 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7219 @end table
7220
7221 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7222 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7223 show our source files:
7224
7225 @smallexample
7226 $ cat sample.c
7227 #include <stdio.h>
7228 #include "sample.h"
7229
7230 #define M 42
7231 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7232
7233 main ()
7234 @{
7235 #define N 28
7236 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7237 #undef N
7238 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7239 #define N 1729
7240 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7241 @}
7242 $ cat sample.h
7243 #define Q <
7244 $
7245 @end smallexample
7246
7247 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7248 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7249 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7250 information.
7251
7252 @smallexample
7253 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7254 $
7255 @end smallexample
7256
7257 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7258
7259 @smallexample
7260 $ gdb -nw sample
7261 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7262 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7263 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7264 (@value{GDBP})
7265 @end smallexample
7266
7267 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7268 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7269 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7270
7271 @smallexample
7272 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7273 3
7274 4 #define M 42
7275 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7276 6
7277 7 main ()
7278 8 @{
7279 9 #define N 28
7280 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7281 11 #undef N
7282 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7283 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7284 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7285 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7286 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7287 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7288 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7289 #define Q <
7290 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7291 expands to: (42 + 1)
7292 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7293 expands to: once (M + 1)
7294 (@value{GDBP})
7295 @end smallexample
7296
7297 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7298 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7299 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7300 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7301
7302 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7303 the source line of the current stack frame:
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7307 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7308 (@value{GDBP}) run
7309 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7310
7311 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7312 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7313 (@value{GDBP})
7314 @end smallexample
7315
7316 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7317
7318 @smallexample
7319 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7320 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7321 #define N 28
7322 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7323 expands to: 28 < 42
7324 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7325 $1 = 1
7326 (@value{GDBP})
7327 @end smallexample
7328
7329 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7330 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7331 thereof) in force at each point:
7332
7333 @smallexample
7334 (@value{GDBP}) next
7335 Hello, world!
7336 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7337 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7338 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7339 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7340 (@value{GDBP}) next
7341 We're so creative.
7342 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7343 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7344 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7345 #define N 1729
7346 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7347 expands to: 1729 < 42
7348 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7349 $2 = 0
7350 (@value{GDBP})
7351 @end smallexample
7352
7353
7354 @node Tracepoints
7355 @chapter Tracepoints
7356 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7357 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7358
7359 @cindex tracepoints
7360 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7361 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7362 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7363 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7364 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7365 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7366 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7367
7368 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7369 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7370 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7371 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7372 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7373 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7374 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7375 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7376 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7377 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7378 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7379
7380 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7381 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7382 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7383 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7384 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7385 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7386 Packets}.
7387
7388 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7389
7390 @menu
7391 * Set Tracepoints::
7392 * Analyze Collected Data::
7393 * Tracepoint Variables::
7394 @end menu
7395
7396 @node Set Tracepoints
7397 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7398
7399 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7400 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7401 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7402 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7403 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7404 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7405 work on.
7406
7407 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7408 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7409 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7410 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7411 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7412 tracepoint was hit.
7413
7414 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7415 conditions and actions.
7416
7417 @menu
7418 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7419 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7420 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7421 * Tracepoint Actions::
7422 * Listing Tracepoints::
7423 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7424 @end menu
7425
7426 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7427 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7428
7429 @table @code
7430 @cindex set tracepoint
7431 @kindex trace
7432 @item trace
7433 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7434 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7435 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7436 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7437 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7438 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7439 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7440 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7441 running.
7442
7443 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7444
7445 @smallexample
7446 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7447
7448 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7449
7450 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7451
7452 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7453
7454 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7455 @end smallexample
7456
7457 @noindent
7458 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7459
7460 @vindex $tpnum
7461 @cindex last tracepoint number
7462 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7463 @cindex tracepoint number
7464 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7465 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7466
7467 @kindex delete tracepoint
7468 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7469 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7470 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7471 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7472
7473 Examples:
7474
7475 @smallexample
7476 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7477
7478 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7479 @end smallexample
7480
7481 @noindent
7482 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7483 @end table
7484
7485 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7486 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7487
7488 @table @code
7489 @kindex disable tracepoint
7490 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7491 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7492 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7493 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7494 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7495
7496 @kindex enable tracepoint
7497 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7498 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7499 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7500 run.
7501 @end table
7502
7503 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7504 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7505
7506 @table @code
7507 @kindex passcount
7508 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7509 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7510 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7511 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7512 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7513 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7514 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7515 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7516 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7517 user.
7518
7519 Examples:
7520
7521 @smallexample
7522 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7523 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7524
7525 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7526 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7527 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7528 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7529 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7530 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7531 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7532 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7533 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7534 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7535 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7536 @end smallexample
7537 @end table
7538
7539 @node Tracepoint Actions
7540 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7541
7542 @table @code
7543 @kindex actions
7544 @cindex tracepoint actions
7545 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7546 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7547 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7548 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7549 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7550 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7551 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7552 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7553 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7554 @code{while-stepping}.
7555
7556 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7557 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7558 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7559
7560 @smallexample
7561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7562
7563 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7564
7565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7566 @end smallexample
7567
7568 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7569 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7570 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7571 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7572 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7573 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7574 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7575 @code{end} command.
7576
7577 @smallexample
7578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7580 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7581 > collect bar,baz
7582 > collect $regs
7583 > while-stepping 12
7584 > collect $fp, $sp
7585 > end
7586 end
7587 @end smallexample
7588
7589 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7590 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7591 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7592 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7593 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7594 special arguments are supported:
7595
7596 @table @code
7597 @item $regs
7598 collect all registers
7599
7600 @item $args
7601 collect all function arguments
7602
7603 @item $locals
7604 collect all local variables.
7605 @end table
7606
7607 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7608 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7609 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7610
7611 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7612 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7613
7614 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7615 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7616 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7617 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7618 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7619 its own @code{end} command):
7620
7621 @smallexample
7622 > while-stepping 12
7623 > collect $regs, myglobal
7624 > end
7625 >
7626 @end smallexample
7627
7628 @noindent
7629 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7630 @code{stepping}.
7631 @end table
7632
7633 @node Listing Tracepoints
7634 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7635
7636 @table @code
7637 @kindex info tracepoints
7638 @kindex info tp
7639 @cindex information about tracepoints
7640 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7641 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7642 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7643 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7644 shown:
7645
7646 @itemize @bullet
7647 @item
7648 its number
7649 @item
7650 whether it is enabled or disabled
7651 @item
7652 its address
7653 @item
7654 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7655 @item
7656 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7657 @item
7658 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7659 @item
7660 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7661 @end itemize
7662
7663 @smallexample
7664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7665 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7666 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7667 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7668 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7669 (@value{GDBP})
7670 @end smallexample
7671
7672 @noindent
7673 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7674 @end table
7675
7676 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7677 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7678
7679 @table @code
7680 @kindex tstart
7681 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7682 @cindex collected data discarded
7683 @item tstart
7684 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7685 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7686 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7687 experiment.
7688
7689 @kindex tstop
7690 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7691 @item tstop
7692 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7693 stops collecting data.
7694
7695 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7696 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7697 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7698
7699 @kindex tstatus
7700 @cindex status of trace data collection
7701 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7702 @item tstatus
7703 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7704 collection.
7705 @end table
7706
7707 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7708
7709 @smallexample
7710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7712 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7713 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7714 > while-stepping 11
7715 > collect $regs
7716 > end
7717 > end
7718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7719 [time passes @dots{}]
7720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7721 @end smallexample
7722
7723
7724 @node Analyze Collected Data
7725 @section Using the collected data
7726
7727 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7728 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7729 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7730 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7731 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7732 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7733 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7734 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7735 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7736 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7737 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7738 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7739 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7740 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7741 the buffer will fail.
7742
7743 @menu
7744 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7745 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7746 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7747 @end menu
7748
7749 @node tfind
7750 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7751
7752 @kindex tfind
7753 @cindex select trace snapshot
7754 @cindex find trace snapshot
7755 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7756 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7757 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7758 snapshot is selected.
7759
7760 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7761
7762 @table @code
7763 @item tfind start
7764 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7765 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7766
7767 @item tfind none
7768 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7769
7770 @item tfind end
7771 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7772
7773 @item tfind
7774 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7775
7776 @item tfind -
7777 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7778 retracing earlier steps.
7779
7780 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7781 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7782 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7783 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7784 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7785
7786 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
7787 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7788 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7789 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7790 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7791
7792 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7793 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7794 addresses.
7795
7796 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7797 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7798 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7799
7800 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7801 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7802 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7803 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7804 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7805 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7806 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7807 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7808 @end table
7809
7810 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7811 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7812 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7813 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7814 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7815 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7816 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7817 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7818 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7819 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7820 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7821 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7822 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7823 tracepoint as the current one.
7824
7825 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
7826 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
7827 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
7828 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
7829 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
7830
7831 @smallexample
7832 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7833 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7834 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
7835 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
7836 > tfind
7837 > end
7838
7839 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
7840 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
7841 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
7842 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
7843 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
7844 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
7845 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
7846 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
7847 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
7848 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
7849 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
7850 @end smallexample
7851
7852 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
7853 the buffer:
7854
7855 @smallexample
7856 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7857 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
7858 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
7859 > tfind line
7860 > end
7861
7862 Frame 0, X = 1
7863 Frame 7, X = 2
7864 Frame 13, X = 255
7865 @end smallexample
7866
7867 @node tdump
7868 @subsection @code{tdump}
7869 @kindex tdump
7870 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
7871 @cindex tracepoint data, display
7872
7873 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
7874 the current trace snapshot.
7875
7876 @smallexample
7877 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
7878 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7879 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
7880 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
7881 > end
7882
7883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7884
7885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
7886 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
7887 at gdb_test.c:444
7888 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
7889
7890 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
7891 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
7892 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
7893 d1 0x18 24
7894 d2 0x80 128
7895 d3 0x33 51
7896 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
7897 d5 0x22 34
7898 d6 0xe0 224
7899 d7 0x380035 3670069
7900 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
7901 a1 0x3000668 50333288
7902 a2 0x100 256
7903 a3 0x322000 3284992
7904 a4 0x3000698 50333336
7905 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
7906 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
7907 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
7908 ps 0x0 0
7909 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
7910 fpcontrol 0x0 0
7911 fpstatus 0x0 0
7912 fpiaddr 0x0 0
7913 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
7914 p1 = (void *) 0x11
7915 p2 = (void *) 0x22
7916 p3 = (void *) 0x33
7917 p4 = (void *) 0x44
7918 p5 = (void *) 0x55
7919 p6 = (void *) 0x66
7920 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
7921
7922 (@value{GDBP})
7923 @end smallexample
7924
7925 @node save-tracepoints
7926 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
7927 @kindex save-tracepoints
7928 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
7929
7930 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7931 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7932 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7933 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7934 Files}).
7935
7936 @node Tracepoint Variables
7937 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7938 @cindex tracepoint variables
7939 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7940
7941 @table @code
7942 @vindex $trace_frame
7943 @item (int) $trace_frame
7944 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7945 snapshot is selected.
7946
7947 @vindex $tracepoint
7948 @item (int) $tracepoint
7949 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7950
7951 @vindex $trace_line
7952 @item (int) $trace_line
7953 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7954
7955 @vindex $trace_file
7956 @item (char []) $trace_file
7957 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7958
7959 @vindex $trace_func
7960 @item (char []) $trace_func
7961 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7962 @end table
7963
7964 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7965 use @code{output} instead.
7966
7967 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7968 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7969 data.
7970
7971 @smallexample
7972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7973
7974 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7975 > output $trace_file
7976 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7977 > tfind
7978 > end
7979 @end smallexample
7980
7981 @node Overlays
7982 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7983 @cindex overlays
7984
7985 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7986 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7987 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7988 use overlays.
7989
7990 @menu
7991 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7992 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7993 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7994 mapped by asking the inferior.
7995 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7996 @end menu
7997
7998 @node How Overlays Work
7999 @section How Overlays Work
8000 @cindex mapped overlays
8001 @cindex unmapped overlays
8002 @cindex load address, overlay's
8003 @cindex mapped address
8004 @cindex overlay area
8005
8006 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8007 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8008 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8009 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8010 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8011
8012 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8013 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8014 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8015 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8016 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8017 largest overlay as well.
8018
8019 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8020 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8021 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8022 there.
8023
8024 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8025 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8026 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8027
8028 @smallexample
8029 @group
8030 Data Instruction Larger
8031 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8032 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8033 | | | | | |
8034 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8035 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8036 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8037 | and heap | | | | | |
8038 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8039 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8040 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8041 | | | | | |
8042 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8043 address | | | | | |
8044 | overlay | <-' | | |
8045 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8046 | | <---. | | load address
8047 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8048 | | | |
8049 +-----------+ | |
8050 +-----------+
8051 | |
8052 +-----------+
8053
8054 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8055 @end group
8056 @end smallexample
8057
8058 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8059 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8060 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8061 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8062 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8063 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8064 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8065 program and the overlay area.
8066
8067 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8068 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8069 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8070 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8071 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8072 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8073 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8074
8075 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8076 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8077 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8078
8079 @itemize @bullet
8080
8081 @item
8082 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8083 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8084 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8085 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8086
8087 @item
8088 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8089 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8090 your program's performance.
8091
8092 @item
8093 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8094 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8095 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8096 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8097 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8098 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8099 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8100
8101 @item
8102 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8103 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8104 instruction and data spaces.
8105
8106 @end itemize
8107
8108 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8109 improved in many ways:
8110
8111 @itemize @bullet
8112
8113 @item
8114 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8115 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8116 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8117 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8118 area in the usual way.
8119
8120 @item
8121 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8122 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8123
8124 @item
8125 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8126 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8127 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8128 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8129 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8130 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8131 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8132
8133 @end itemize
8134
8135
8136 @node Overlay Commands
8137 @section Overlay Commands
8138
8139 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8140 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8141 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8142 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8143 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8144 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8145
8146 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8147 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8148
8149 @table @code
8150 @item overlay off
8151 @kindex overlay
8152 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8153 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8154 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8155 overlay support is disabled.
8156
8157 @item overlay manual
8158 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8159 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8160 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8161 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8162 commands described below.
8163
8164 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8165 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8166 @cindex map an overlay
8167 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8168 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8169 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8170 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8171 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8172 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8173
8174 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8175 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8176 @cindex unmap an overlay
8177 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8178 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8179 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8180 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8181
8182 @item overlay auto
8183 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8184 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8185 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8186 Overlay Debugging}.
8187
8188 @item overlay load-target
8189 @itemx overlay load
8190 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8191 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8192 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8193 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8194 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8195 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8196
8197 @item overlay list-overlays
8198 @itemx overlay list
8199 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8200 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8201 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8202
8203 @end table
8204
8205 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8206 of the function the address falls in:
8207
8208 @smallexample
8209 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8210 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8211 @end smallexample
8212 @noindent
8213 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8214 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8215 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8216 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8217
8218 @smallexample
8219 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8220 No sections are mapped.
8221 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8222 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8223 @end smallexample
8224 @noindent
8225 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8226 name normally:
8227
8228 @smallexample
8229 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8230 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8231 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8232 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8233 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8234 @end smallexample
8235
8236 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8237 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8238 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8239 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8240 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8241
8242 @itemize @bullet
8243 @item
8244 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8245 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8246 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8247 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8248 @item
8249 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8250 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8251 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8252 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8253 breakpoints properly.
8254 @end itemize
8255
8256
8257 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8258 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8259 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8260
8261 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8262 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8263 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8264 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8265 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8266 current state of the overlays.
8267
8268 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8269 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8270
8271 @table @asis
8272
8273 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8274 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8275
8276 @smallexample
8277 struct
8278 @{
8279 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8280 unsigned long vma;
8281
8282 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8283 unsigned long size;
8284
8285 /* The overlay's load address. */
8286 unsigned long lma;
8287
8288 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8289 zero otherwise. */
8290 unsigned long mapped;
8291 @}
8292 @end smallexample
8293
8294 @item @code{_novlys}:
8295 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8296 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8297
8298 @end table
8299
8300 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8301 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8302 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8303 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8304 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8305 currently mapped.
8306
8307 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8308 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8309 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8310 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8311 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8312 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8313 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8314 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8315 are not being executed.
8316
8317 @node Overlay Sample Program
8318 @section Overlay Sample Program
8319 @cindex overlay example program
8320
8321 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8322 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8323 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8324 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8325 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8326 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8327 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8328
8329 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8330 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8331 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8332 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8333
8334 @table @file
8335 @item overlays.c
8336 The main program file.
8337 @item ovlymgr.c
8338 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8339 @item foo.c
8340 @itemx bar.c
8341 @itemx baz.c
8342 @itemx grbx.c
8343 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8344 @item d10v.ld
8345 @itemx m32r.ld
8346 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8347 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8348 @end table
8349
8350 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8351 cross-compiler like this:
8352
8353 @smallexample
8354 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8355 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8356 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8357 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8358 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8359 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8360 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8361 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8362 @end smallexample
8363
8364 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8365 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8366 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8367
8368
8369 @node Languages
8370 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8371 @cindex languages
8372
8373 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8374 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8375 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8376 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8377 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8378 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8379
8380 @cindex working language
8381 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8382 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8383 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8384 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8385 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8386 language}.
8387
8388 @menu
8389 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8390 * Show:: Displaying the language
8391 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8392 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8393 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8394 @end menu
8395
8396 @node Setting
8397 @section Switching between source languages
8398
8399 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8400 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8401 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8402 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8403 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8404 are printed, etc.
8405
8406 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8407 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8408 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8409 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8410 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8411 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8412 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8413 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8414 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8415 Displaying the language}.
8416
8417 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8418 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8419 another language. In that case, make the
8420 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8421 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8422 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8423
8424 @menu
8425 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8426 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8427 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8428 @end menu
8429
8430 @node Filenames
8431 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8432
8433 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8434 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8435
8436 @table @file
8437 @item .ada
8438 @itemx .ads
8439 @itemx .adb
8440 @itemx .a
8441 Ada source file.
8442
8443 @item .c
8444 C source file
8445
8446 @item .C
8447 @itemx .cc
8448 @itemx .cp
8449 @itemx .cpp
8450 @itemx .cxx
8451 @itemx .c++
8452 C@t{++} source file
8453
8454 @item .m
8455 Objective-C source file
8456
8457 @item .f
8458 @itemx .F
8459 Fortran source file
8460
8461 @item .mod
8462 Modula-2 source file
8463
8464 @item .s
8465 @itemx .S
8466 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8467 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8468 @end table
8469
8470 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8471 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8472
8473 @node Manually
8474 @subsection Setting the working language
8475
8476 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8477 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8478 your program.
8479
8480 @kindex set language
8481 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8482 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8483 a language, such as
8484 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8485 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8486
8487 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8488 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8489 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8490 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8491 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8492 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8493 command such as:
8494
8495 @smallexample
8496 print a = b + c
8497 @end smallexample
8498
8499 @noindent
8500 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8501 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8502 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8503 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8504
8505 @node Automatically
8506 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8507
8508 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8509 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8510 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8511 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8512 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8513 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8514 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8515 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8516 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8517
8518 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8519 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8520 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8521 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8522 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8523
8524 @node Show
8525 @section Displaying the language
8526
8527 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8528 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8529
8530 @table @code
8531 @item show language
8532 @kindex show language
8533 Display the current working language. This is the
8534 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8535 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8536
8537 @item info frame
8538 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8539 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8540 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8541 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8542 information listed here.
8543
8544 @item info source
8545 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8546 Display the source language of this source file.
8547 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8548 information listed here.
8549 @end table
8550
8551 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8552 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8553 with a language explicitly:
8554
8555 @table @code
8556 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8557 @kindex set extension-language
8558 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8559 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8560
8561 @item info extensions
8562 @kindex info extensions
8563 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8564 @end table
8565
8566 @node Checks
8567 @section Type and range checking
8568
8569 @quotation
8570 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8571 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8572 section documents the intended facilities.
8573 @end quotation
8574 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8575
8576 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8577 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8578 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8579 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8580 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8581 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8582 errors when your program is running.
8583
8584 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8585 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8586 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8587 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8588 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8589 automatically based on your program's source language.
8590 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8591 settings of supported languages.
8592
8593 @menu
8594 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8595 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8596 @end menu
8597
8598 @cindex type checking
8599 @cindex checks, type
8600 @node Type Checking
8601 @subsection An overview of type checking
8602
8603 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8604 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8605 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8606 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8607
8608 @smallexample
8609 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8610 @exdent but
8611 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8612 @end smallexample
8613
8614 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8615 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8616
8617 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8618 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8619 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8620 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8621 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8622 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8623 also issues a warning.
8624
8625 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8626 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8627 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8628 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8629 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8630 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8631
8632 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8633 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8634 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8635 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8636 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8637 details on specific languages.
8638
8639 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8640
8641 @kindex set check type
8642 @kindex show check type
8643 @table @code
8644 @item set check type auto
8645 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8646 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8647 each language.
8648
8649 @item set check type on
8650 @itemx set check type off
8651 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8652 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8653 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8654 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8655 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8656
8657 @item set check type warn
8658 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8659 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8660 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8661 numbers and structures.
8662
8663 @item show type
8664 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8665 is setting it automatically.
8666 @end table
8667
8668 @cindex range checking
8669 @cindex checks, range
8670 @node Range Checking
8671 @subsection An overview of range checking
8672
8673 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8674 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8675 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8676 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8677 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8678
8679 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8680 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8681 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8682 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8683
8684 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8685 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8686 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8687 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8688 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8689 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8690
8691 @smallexample
8692 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8693 @end smallexample
8694
8695 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8696 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8697 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8698
8699 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8700
8701 @kindex set check range
8702 @kindex show check range
8703 @table @code
8704 @item set check range auto
8705 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8706 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8707 each language.
8708
8709 @item set check range on
8710 @itemx set check range off
8711 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8712 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8713 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8714 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8715
8716 @item set check range warn
8717 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8718 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8719 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8720 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8721 systems).
8722
8723 @item show range
8724 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8725 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8726 @end table
8727
8728 @node Supported languages
8729 @section Supported languages
8730
8731 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8732 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8733 @c This is false ...
8734 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8735 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8736 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8737 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8738 language.
8739
8740 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8741 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8742 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8743 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8744 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8745 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8746 language reference or tutorial.
8747
8748 @menu
8749 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8750 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8751 * Fortran:: Fortran
8752 * Pascal:: Pascal
8753 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8754 * Ada:: Ada
8755 @end menu
8756
8757 @node C
8758 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8759
8760 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8761 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8762
8763 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8764 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8765 together.
8766
8767 @cindex C@t{++}
8768 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8769 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8770 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8771 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8772 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8773 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8774 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8775
8776 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8777 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8778 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8779 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8780 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8781 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8782
8783 @menu
8784 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8785 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8786 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8787 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8788 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8789 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
8790 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8791 @end menu
8792
8793 @node C Operators
8794 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
8795
8796 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
8797
8798 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8799 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8800 often defined on groups of types.
8801
8802 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
8803
8804 @itemize @bullet
8805
8806 @item
8807 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
8808 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
8809
8810 @item
8811 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8812 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
8813
8814 @item
8815 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
8816
8817 @item
8818 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
8819
8820 @end itemize
8821
8822 @noindent
8823 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
8824 in order of increasing precedence:
8825
8826 @table @code
8827 @item ,
8828 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
8829 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
8830 expression being the last expression evaluated.
8831
8832 @item =
8833 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
8834 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
8835
8836 @item @var{op}=
8837 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
8838 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
8839 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
8840 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
8841 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
8842
8843 @item ?:
8844 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
8845 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
8846 integral type.
8847
8848 @item ||
8849 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8850
8851 @item &&
8852 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8853
8854 @item |
8855 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8856
8857 @item ^
8858 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
8859
8860 @item &
8861 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
8862
8863 @item ==@r{, }!=
8864 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
8865 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
8866
8867 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
8868 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
8869 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
8870 and non-zero for true.
8871
8872 @item <<@r{, }>>
8873 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
8874
8875 @item @@
8876 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8877
8878 @item +@r{, }-
8879 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
8880 pointer types.
8881
8882 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
8883 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
8884 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
8885 integral types.
8886
8887 @item ++@r{, }--
8888 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
8889 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
8890 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
8891 operation takes place.
8892
8893 @item *
8894 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
8895 @code{++}.
8896
8897 @item &
8898 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
8899
8900 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
8901 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
8902 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
8903 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
8904 stored.
8905
8906 @item -
8907 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
8908 precedence as @code{++}.
8909
8910 @item !
8911 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8912 @code{++}.
8913
8914 @item ~
8915 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
8916 @code{++}.
8917
8918
8919 @item .@r{, }->
8920 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
8921 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
8922 pointer based on the stored type information.
8923 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
8924
8925 @item .*@r{, }->*
8926 Dereferences of pointers to members.
8927
8928 @item []
8929 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
8930 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8931
8932 @item ()
8933 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8934
8935 @item ::
8936 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
8937 and @code{class} types.
8938
8939 @item ::
8940 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8941 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8942 above.
8943 @end table
8944
8945 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8946 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8947 predefined meaning.
8948
8949 @menu
8950 * C Constants::
8951 @end menu
8952
8953 @node C Constants
8954 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
8955
8956 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8957
8958 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8959 following ways:
8960
8961 @itemize @bullet
8962 @item
8963 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8964 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8965 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8966 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8967 @code{long} value.
8968
8969 @item
8970 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8971 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8972 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8973 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8974 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8975 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8976 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8977 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8978 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8979 constant.
8980
8981 @item
8982 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8983 integral equivalents.
8984
8985 @item
8986 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8987 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8988 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8989 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8990 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8991 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8992 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8993 @samp{\n} for newline.
8994
8995 @item
8996 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8997 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8998 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8999 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9000 characters.
9001
9002 @item
9003 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9004 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9005
9006 @item
9007 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9008 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9009 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9010 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9011 @end itemize
9012
9013 @menu
9014 * C plus plus expressions::
9015 * C Defaults::
9016 * C Checks::
9017
9018 * Debugging C::
9019 @end menu
9020
9021 @node C plus plus expressions
9022 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9023
9024 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9025 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9026
9027 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9028 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9029 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9030 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9031 @quotation
9032 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9033 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9034 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9035 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9036 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9037 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9038 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9039 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9040 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9041 C@t{++} code.
9042 @end quotation
9043
9044 @enumerate
9045
9046 @cindex member functions
9047 @item
9048 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9049
9050 @smallexample
9051 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9052 @end smallexample
9053
9054 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9055 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9056 @item
9057 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9058 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9059 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9060 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9061
9062 @cindex call overloaded functions
9063 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9064 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9065 @item
9066 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9067 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9068 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9069 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9070 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9071 default arguments.
9072
9073 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9074 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9075 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9076 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9077 number of function arguments.
9078
9079 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9080 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9081 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9082
9083 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9084 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9085 @smallexample
9086 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9087 @end smallexample
9088
9089 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9090 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9091
9092 @cindex reference declarations
9093 @item
9094 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9095 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9096 dereferenced.
9097
9098 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9099 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9100 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9101 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9102 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9103
9104 @item
9105 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9106 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9107 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9108 necessary, for example in an expression like
9109 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9110 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9111 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9112 @end enumerate
9113
9114 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9115 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9116 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9117 invoking user-defined operators.
9118
9119 @node C Defaults
9120 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9121
9122 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9123
9124 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9125 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9126 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9127 selects the working language.
9128
9129 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9130 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9131 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9132 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9133 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9134 for further details.
9135
9136 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9137 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9138 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9139
9140 @node C Checks
9141 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9142
9143 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9144
9145 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9146 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9147 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9148
9149 @itemize @bullet
9150 @item
9151 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9152 enumerated tag.
9153
9154 @item
9155 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9156 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9157
9158 @ignore
9159 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9160 @c FIXME--beers?
9161 @item
9162 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9163 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9164 compilers.)
9165 @end ignore
9166 @end itemize
9167
9168 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9169 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9170 that is not itself an array.
9171
9172 @node Debugging C
9173 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9174
9175 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9176 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9177 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9178 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9179
9180 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9181 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9182 ,Expressions}.
9183
9184 @menu
9185 * Debugging C plus plus::
9186 @end menu
9187
9188 @node Debugging C plus plus
9189 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9190
9191 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9192
9193 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9194 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9195
9196 @table @code
9197 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9198 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9199 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9200 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9201 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9202
9203 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9204 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9205 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9206 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9207 classes.
9208 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9209
9210 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9211 @item catch throw
9212 @itemx catch catch
9213 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9214 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9215
9216 @cindex inheritance
9217 @item ptype @var{typename}
9218 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9219 @var{typename}.
9220 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9221
9222 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9223 @item set print demangle
9224 @itemx show print demangle
9225 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9226 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9227 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9228 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9229 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9230
9231 @item set print object
9232 @itemx show print object
9233 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9234 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9235
9236 @item set print vtbl
9237 @itemx show print vtbl
9238 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9239 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9240 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9241 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9242
9243 @kindex set overload-resolution
9244 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9245 @item set overload-resolution on
9246 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9247 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9248 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9249 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9250 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9251 message.
9252
9253 @item set overload-resolution off
9254 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9255 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9256 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9257 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9258 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9259 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9260 argument types.
9261
9262 @kindex show overload-resolution
9263 @item show overload-resolution
9264 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9265
9266 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9267 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9268 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9269 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9270 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9271 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9272 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9273 @end table
9274
9275 @node Objective-C
9276 @subsection Objective-C
9277
9278 @cindex Objective-C
9279 This section provides information about some commands and command
9280 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9281 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9282 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9283
9284 @menu
9285 * Method Names in Commands::
9286 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9287 @end menu
9288
9289 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9290 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9291
9292 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9293 names as line specifications:
9294
9295 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9296 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9297 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9298 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9299 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9300 @itemize
9301 @item @code{clear}
9302 @item @code{break}
9303 @item @code{info line}
9304 @item @code{jump}
9305 @item @code{list}
9306 @end itemize
9307
9308 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9309
9310 @smallexample
9311 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9312 @end smallexample
9313
9314 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9315 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9316 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9317 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9318 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9319 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9320 debugged, enter:
9321
9322 @smallexample
9323 break -[Fruit create]
9324 @end smallexample
9325
9326 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9327 enter:
9328
9329 @smallexample
9330 list +[NSText initialize]
9331 @end smallexample
9332
9333 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9334 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9335 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9336 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9337
9338 @smallexample
9339 break create
9340 @end smallexample
9341
9342 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9343 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9344 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9345 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9346 none apply.
9347
9348 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9349 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9350
9351 @smallexample
9352 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9353 @end smallexample
9354
9355 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9356 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9357 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9358 @kindex print-object
9359 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9360
9361 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9362
9363 @smallexample
9364 print -[@var{object} hash]
9365 @end smallexample
9366
9367 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9368 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9369 @noindent
9370 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9371 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9372 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9373 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9374 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9375 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9376
9377 @node Fortran
9378 @subsection Fortran
9379 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9380
9381 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9382 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9383
9384 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9385 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9386 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9387 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9388 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9389 underscore.
9390
9391 @menu
9392 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9393 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9394 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9395 @end menu
9396
9397 @node Fortran Operators
9398 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9399
9400 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9401
9402 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9403 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9404 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9405
9406 @table @code
9407 @item **
9408 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9409 of the second one.
9410
9411 @item :
9412 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9413 represent a section of array.
9414 @end table
9415
9416 @node Fortran Defaults
9417 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9418
9419 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9420
9421 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9422 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9423 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9424 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9425
9426 @node Special Fortran commands
9427 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9428
9429 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9430
9431 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9432 such as common block displaying.
9433
9434 @table @code
9435 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9436 @kindex info common
9437 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9438 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9439 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9440 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9441 printed.
9442 @end table
9443
9444 @node Pascal
9445 @subsection Pascal
9446
9447 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9448 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9449 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9450 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9451 syntax.
9452
9453 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9454 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9455 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9456
9457 @node Modula-2
9458 @subsection Modula-2
9459
9460 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9461
9462 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9463 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9464 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9465 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9466 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9467 table.
9468
9469 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9470 @menu
9471 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9472 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9473 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9474 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9475 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9476 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9477 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9478 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9479 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9480 @end menu
9481
9482 @node M2 Operators
9483 @subsubsection Operators
9484 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9485
9486 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9487 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9488 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9489 following definitions hold:
9490
9491 @itemize @bullet
9492
9493 @item
9494 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9495 their subranges.
9496
9497 @item
9498 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9499
9500 @item
9501 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9502
9503 @item
9504 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9505 @var{type}}.
9506
9507 @item
9508 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9509
9510 @item
9511 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9512
9513 @item
9514 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9515 @end itemize
9516
9517 @noindent
9518 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9519 increasing precedence:
9520
9521 @table @code
9522 @item ,
9523 Function argument or array index separator.
9524
9525 @item :=
9526 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9527 @var{value}.
9528
9529 @item <@r{, }>
9530 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9531 types.
9532
9533 @item <=@r{, }>=
9534 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9535 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9536 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9537
9538 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9539 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9540 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9541 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9542 comment character.
9543
9544 @item IN
9545 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9546 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9547
9548 @item OR
9549 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9550
9551 @item AND@r{, }&
9552 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9553
9554 @item @@
9555 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9556
9557 @item +@r{, }-
9558 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9559 and difference on set types.
9560
9561 @item *
9562 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9563 on set types.
9564
9565 @item /
9566 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9567 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9568
9569 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9570 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9571 precedence as @code{*}.
9572
9573 @item -
9574 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9575
9576 @item ^
9577 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9578
9579 @item NOT
9580 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9581 @code{^}.
9582
9583 @item .
9584 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9585 precedence as @code{^}.
9586
9587 @item []
9588 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9589
9590 @item ()
9591 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9592 as @code{^}.
9593
9594 @item ::@r{, }.
9595 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9596 @end table
9597
9598 @quotation
9599 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9600 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9601 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9602 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9603 @end quotation
9604
9605
9606 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9607 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9608 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9609
9610 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9611 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9612
9613 @table @var
9614
9615 @item a
9616 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9617
9618 @item c
9619 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9620
9621 @item i
9622 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9623
9624 @item m
9625 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9626 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9627 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9628
9629 @item n
9630 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9631
9632 @item r
9633 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9634
9635 @item t
9636 represents a type.
9637
9638 @item v
9639 represents a variable.
9640
9641 @item x
9642 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9643 explanation of the function for details.
9644 @end table
9645
9646 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9647
9648 @table @code
9649 @item ABS(@var{n})
9650 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9651
9652 @item CAP(@var{c})
9653 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9654 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9655
9656 @item CHR(@var{i})
9657 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9658
9659 @item DEC(@var{v})
9660 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9661
9662 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9663 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9664 new value.
9665
9666 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9667 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9668 set.
9669
9670 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9671 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9672
9673 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9674 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9675
9676 @item INC(@var{v})
9677 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9678
9679 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9680 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9681 new value.
9682
9683 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9684 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9685 there. Returns the new set.
9686
9687 @item MAX(@var{t})
9688 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9689
9690 @item MIN(@var{t})
9691 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9692
9693 @item ODD(@var{i})
9694 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9695
9696 @item ORD(@var{x})
9697 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9698 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9699 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9700 integral, character and enumerated types.
9701
9702 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9703 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9704
9705 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9706 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9707
9708 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9709 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9710 @end table
9711
9712 @quotation
9713 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9714 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9715 an error.
9716 @end quotation
9717
9718 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9719 @node M2 Constants
9720 @subsubsection Constants
9721
9722 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9723 ways:
9724
9725 @itemize @bullet
9726
9727 @item
9728 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9729 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9730 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9731 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9732
9733 @item
9734 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9735 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9736 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9737 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9738 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9739 digits.
9740
9741 @item
9742 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9743 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9744 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9745 followed by a @samp{C}.
9746
9747 @item
9748 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9749 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9750 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9751 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9752 sequences.
9753
9754 @item
9755 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9756
9757 @item
9758 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9759 @code{FALSE}.
9760
9761 @item
9762 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9763
9764 @item
9765 Set constants are not yet supported.
9766 @end itemize
9767
9768 @node M2 Types
9769 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9770 @cindex Modula-2 types
9771
9772 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9773 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9774 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9775 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9776 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9777 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9778
9779 The first example contains the following section of code:
9780
9781 @smallexample
9782 VAR
9783 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9784 r: [20..40] ;
9785 @end smallexample
9786
9787 @noindent
9788 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
9789 @code{r} and @code{s}.
9790
9791 @smallexample
9792 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9793 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
9794 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9795 SET OF CHAR
9796 (@value{GDBP}) print r
9797 21
9798 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
9799 [20..40]
9800 @end smallexample
9801
9802 @noindent
9803 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
9804
9805 @smallexample
9806 VAR
9807 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
9808 @end smallexample
9809
9810 @noindent
9811 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
9812
9813 @smallexample
9814 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9815 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
9816 @end smallexample
9817
9818 @noindent
9819 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
9820 expressions using the debugger.
9821
9822 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
9823 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
9824
9825 @smallexample
9826 VAR
9827 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
9828 @end smallexample
9829
9830 @smallexample
9831 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9832 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
9833 @end smallexample
9834
9835 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
9836 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
9837 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
9838 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
9839
9840 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
9841
9842 @smallexample
9843 TYPE
9844 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
9845 t = [blue..yellow] ;
9846 VAR
9847 s: t ;
9848 BEGIN
9849 s := blue ;
9850 @end smallexample
9851
9852 @noindent
9853 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
9854 and value of a variable.
9855
9856 @smallexample
9857 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9858 $1 = blue
9859 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
9860 type = [blue..yellow]
9861 @end smallexample
9862
9863 @noindent
9864 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
9865 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
9866 their @code{C} counterparts.
9867
9868 @smallexample
9869 VAR
9870 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
9871 BEGIN
9872 s[1] := 1 ;
9873 @end smallexample
9874
9875 @smallexample
9876 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9877 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
9878 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9879 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
9880 @end smallexample
9881
9882 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
9883 pointer types as shown in this example:
9884
9885 @smallexample
9886 VAR
9887 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
9888 BEGIN
9889 NEW(s) ;
9890 s^[1] := 1 ;
9891 @end smallexample
9892
9893 @noindent
9894 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
9895
9896 @smallexample
9897 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9898 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
9899 @end smallexample
9900
9901 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
9902 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
9903 types:
9904
9905 @smallexample
9906 TYPE
9907 foo = RECORD
9908 f1: CARDINAL ;
9909 f2: CHAR ;
9910 f3: myarray ;
9911 END ;
9912
9913 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
9914 myrange = [-2..2] ;
9915 VAR
9916 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
9917 @end smallexample
9918
9919 @noindent
9920 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
9921 below.
9922
9923 @smallexample
9924 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9925 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
9926 f1 : CARDINAL;
9927 f2 : CHAR;
9928 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
9929 END
9930 @end smallexample
9931
9932 @node M2 Defaults
9933 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
9934 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
9935
9936 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
9937 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
9938 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9939 selected the working language.
9940
9941 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
9942 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
9943 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
9944 the language automatically}, for further details.
9945
9946 @node Deviations
9947 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
9948 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
9949
9950 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
9951 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
9952
9953 @itemize @bullet
9954 @item
9955 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
9956 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
9957 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
9958 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
9959 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
9960 returned a pointer.)
9961
9962 @item
9963 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
9964 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
9965 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
9966 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
9967
9968 @item
9969 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
9970 argument.
9971
9972 @item
9973 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
9974 @end itemize
9975
9976 @node M2 Checks
9977 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
9978 @cindex Modula-2 checks
9979
9980 @quotation
9981 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
9982 range checking.
9983 @end quotation
9984 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
9985
9986 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
9987
9988 @itemize @bullet
9989 @item
9990 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
9991 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
9992
9993 @item
9994 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
9995 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
9996 @end itemize
9997
9998 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
9999 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10000
10001 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10002 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10003
10004 @node M2 Scope
10005 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10006 @cindex scope
10007 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10008 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10009 @ifinfo
10010 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10011 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10012 @end ifinfo
10013 @iftex
10014 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10015 @end iftex
10016
10017 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10018 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10019 similar syntax:
10020
10021 @smallexample
10022
10023 @var{module} . @var{id}
10024 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10025 @end smallexample
10026
10027 @noindent
10028 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10029 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10030 identifier within your program, except another module.
10031
10032 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10033 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10034 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10035 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10036
10037 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10038 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10039 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10040 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10041 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10042 @var{module}.
10043
10044 @node GDB/M2
10045 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10046
10047 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10048 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10049 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10050 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10051 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10052 analogue in Modula-2.
10053
10054 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10055 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10056 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10057 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10058 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10059 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10060
10061 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10062 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10063 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10064
10065 @node Ada
10066 @subsection Ada
10067 @cindex Ada
10068
10069 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10070 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10071 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10072 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10073 to be difficult.
10074
10075
10076 @cindex expressions in Ada
10077 @menu
10078 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10079 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10080 in @value{GDBN}.
10081 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10082 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10083 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10084 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10085 @end menu
10086
10087 @node Ada Mode Intro
10088 @subsubsection Introduction
10089 @cindex Ada mode, general
10090
10091 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10092 syntax, with some extensions.
10093 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10094
10095 @itemize @bullet
10096 @item
10097 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10098 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10099 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10100 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10101
10102 @item
10103 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10104 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10105
10106 @item
10107 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10108 @end itemize
10109
10110 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10111 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10112 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10113 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10114 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10115
10116 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10117 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10118 was translated from an Ada source file.
10119
10120 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10121 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10122 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10123 middle (to allow based literals).
10124
10125 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10126 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10127 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10128 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10129 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10130 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10131
10132 @node Omissions from Ada
10133 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10134 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10135
10136 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10137
10138 @itemize @bullet
10139 @item
10140 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10141
10142 @itemize @minus
10143 @item
10144 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10145 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10146
10147 @item
10148 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10149
10150 @item
10151 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10152
10153 @item
10154 @t{'Tag}.
10155
10156 @item
10157 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10158 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10159
10160 @item
10161 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10162 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10163
10164 @item
10165 @t{'Address}.
10166 @end itemize
10167
10168 @item
10169 The names in
10170 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10171 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10172 not currently available.
10173
10174 @item
10175 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10176 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10177 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10178 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10179 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10180 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10181 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10182 indeterminate values.
10183
10184 @item
10185 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10186 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10187 are not implemented.
10188
10189 @item
10190 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10191 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10192 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10193 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10194 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10195
10196 @smallexample
10197 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10198 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10199 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10200 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10201 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10202 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10203 @end smallexample
10204
10205 Changing a
10206 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10207 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10208 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10209 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10210 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10211 declared to have a type such as:
10212
10213 @smallexample
10214 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10215 Id : Integer;
10216 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10217 end record;
10218 @end smallexample
10219
10220 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10221 assignments:
10222
10223 @smallexample
10224 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10225 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10226 @end smallexample
10227
10228 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10229 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10230 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10231 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10232 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10233 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10234 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10235 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10236
10237 @item
10238 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10239
10240 @item
10241 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10242 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10243 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10244 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10245 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10246
10247 @item
10248 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10249
10250 @item
10251 Entry calls are not implemented.
10252
10253 @item
10254 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10255 formats are not supported.
10256
10257 @item
10258 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10259 @end itemize
10260
10261 @node Additions to Ada
10262 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10263 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10264
10265 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10266 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10267
10268 @itemize @bullet
10269 @item
10270 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10271 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10272 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10273 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10274 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10275 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10276 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10277 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10278
10279 @item
10280 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10281 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10282 surround it in single quotes.
10283
10284 @item
10285 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10286 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10287
10288 @item
10289 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10290 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10291 @end itemize
10292
10293 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10294 to Ada:
10295
10296 @itemize @bullet
10297 @item
10298 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10299 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10300
10301 @smallexample
10302 set x := y + 3
10303 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10304 @end smallexample
10305
10306 @item
10307 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10308 the value of its right-hand operand.
10309 This allows, for example,
10310 complex conditional breaks:
10311
10312 @smallexample
10313 break f
10314 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10315 @end smallexample
10316
10317 @item
10318 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10319 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10320 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10321 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10322 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10323 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10324 in strings. For example,
10325 @smallexample
10326 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10327 @end smallexample
10328 @noindent
10329 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10330 period.
10331
10332 @item
10333 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10334 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10335 to write
10336
10337 @smallexample
10338 print 'max(x, y)
10339 @end smallexample
10340
10341 @item
10342 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10343 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10344 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10345
10346 @smallexample
10347 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10348 @end smallexample
10349
10350 @noindent
10351 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10352 clause.
10353
10354 @item
10355 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10356 multi-character subsequence of
10357 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10358 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10359 in place of @t{a'length}.
10360
10361 @item
10362 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10363 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10364 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10365 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10366 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10367 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10368 For example,
10369 @smallexample
10370 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10371 @end smallexample
10372
10373 @item
10374 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10375 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10376 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10377 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10378 object.
10379
10380 @end itemize
10381
10382 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10383 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10384
10385 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10386 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10387 before reaching the main procedure.
10388 As defined in the Ada Reference
10389 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10390 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10391 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10392 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10393
10394 @node Ada Glitches
10395 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10396 @cindex Ada, problems
10397
10398 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10399 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10400 @value{GDBN},
10401 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10402 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10403
10404 @itemize @bullet
10405 @item
10406 Currently, the debugger
10407 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10408 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10409 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10410 to get it printed properly.
10411
10412 @item
10413 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10414 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10415
10416 @item
10417 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10418 argument lists are treated as positional).
10419
10420 @item
10421 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10422
10423 @item
10424 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10425 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10426 the host machine.
10427
10428 @item
10429 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10430
10431 @item
10432 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10433 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10434 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10435 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10436 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10437 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10438 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10439 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10440 you can usually resolve the confusion
10441 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10442 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10443 @end itemize
10444
10445 @node Unsupported languages
10446 @section Unsupported languages
10447
10448 @cindex unsupported languages
10449 @cindex minimal language
10450 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10451 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10452 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10453 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10454 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10455 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10456
10457 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10458 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10459 language.
10460
10461 @node Symbols
10462 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10463
10464 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10465 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10466 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10467 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10468 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10469 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10470 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10471
10472 @cindex symbol names
10473 @cindex names of symbols
10474 @cindex quoting names
10475 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10476 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10477 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10478 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10479 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10480 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10481 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10482 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10483
10484 @smallexample
10485 p 'foo.c'::x
10486 @end smallexample
10487
10488 @noindent
10489 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10490
10491 @table @code
10492 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10493 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10494 @kindex set case-sensitive
10495 @item set case-sensitive on
10496 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10497 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10498 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10499 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10500 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10501 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10502 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10503 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10504 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10505 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10506 case-insensitive matches.
10507
10508 @kindex show case-sensitive
10509 @item show case-sensitive
10510 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10511 lookups.
10512
10513 @kindex info address
10514 @cindex address of a symbol
10515 @item info address @var{symbol}
10516 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10517 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10518 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10519 is always stored.
10520
10521 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10522 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10523 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10524
10525 @kindex info symbol
10526 @cindex symbol from address
10527 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10528 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10529 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10530 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10531 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10532
10533 @smallexample
10534 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10535 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10536 @end smallexample
10537
10538 @noindent
10539 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10540 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10541
10542 @kindex whatis
10543 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10544 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10545 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10546 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10547 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10548 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10549 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10550 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10551 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10552 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10553 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10554
10555 @kindex ptype
10556 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10557 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10558 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10559 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10560
10561 For example, for this variable declaration:
10562
10563 @smallexample
10564 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10565 @end smallexample
10566
10567 @noindent
10568 the two commands give this output:
10569
10570 @smallexample
10571 @group
10572 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10573 type = struct complex
10574 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10575 type = struct complex @{
10576 double real;
10577 double imag;
10578 @}
10579 @end group
10580 @end smallexample
10581
10582 @noindent
10583 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10584 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10585
10586 @cindex incomplete type
10587 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10588 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10589 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10590 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10591 given these declarations:
10592
10593 @smallexample
10594 struct foo;
10595 struct foo *fooptr;
10596 @end smallexample
10597
10598 @noindent
10599 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10600
10601 @smallexample
10602 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10603 $1 = <incomplete type>
10604 @end smallexample
10605
10606 @noindent
10607 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10608 completely specified.
10609
10610 @kindex info types
10611 @item info types @var{regexp}
10612 @itemx info types
10613 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10614 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10615 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10616 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10617 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10618 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10619 name is @code{value}.
10620
10621 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10622 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10623 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10624
10625 @kindex info scope
10626 @cindex local variables
10627 @item info scope @var{location}
10628 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10629 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10630 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10631 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10632
10633 @smallexample
10634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10635 Scope for command_line_handler:
10636 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10637 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10638 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10639 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10640 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10641 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10642 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10643 @end smallexample
10644
10645 @noindent
10646 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10647 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10648 collect}.
10649
10650 @kindex info source
10651 @item info source
10652 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10653 the function containing the current point of execution:
10654 @itemize @bullet
10655 @item
10656 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10657 @item
10658 the directory it was compiled in,
10659 @item
10660 its length, in lines,
10661 @item
10662 which programming language it is written in,
10663 @item
10664 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10665 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10666 @item
10667 whether the debugging information includes information about
10668 preprocessor macros.
10669 @end itemize
10670
10671
10672 @kindex info sources
10673 @item info sources
10674 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10675 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10676 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10677
10678 @kindex info functions
10679 @item info functions
10680 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10681
10682 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10683 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10684 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10685 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10686 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10687 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10688 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10689 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10690
10691 @kindex info variables
10692 @item info variables
10693 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10694 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10695
10696 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10697 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10698 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10699 @var{regexp}.
10700
10701 @kindex info classes
10702 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10703 @item info classes
10704 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10705 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10706 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10707 expression.
10708
10709 @kindex info selectors
10710 @item info selectors
10711 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10712 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10713 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10714 expression.
10715
10716 @ignore
10717 This was never implemented.
10718 @kindex info methods
10719 @item info methods
10720 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10721 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10722 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10723 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10724 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10725 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10726 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10727 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10728 @end ignore
10729
10730 @cindex reloading symbols
10731 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10732 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10733 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10734 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10735 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10736
10737 @table @code
10738 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10739 @item set symbol-reloading on
10740 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10741 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10742
10743 @item set symbol-reloading off
10744 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10745 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10746 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10747 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10748 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10749 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10750 name.
10751
10752 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10753 @item show symbol-reloading
10754 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10755 @end table
10756
10757 @cindex opaque data types
10758 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10759 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10760 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10761 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10762 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10763 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10764 another source file. The default is on.
10765
10766 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10767 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10768
10769 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10770 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10771 is printed as follows:
10772 @smallexample
10773 @{<no data fields>@}
10774 @end smallexample
10775
10776 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10777 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10778 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10779
10780 @kindex maint print symbols
10781 @cindex symbol dump
10782 @kindex maint print psymbols
10783 @cindex partial symbol dump
10784 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10785 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10786 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10787 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10788 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10789 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10790 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10791 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10792 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10793 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10794 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10795 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10796 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10797 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
10798 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
10799 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
10800 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
10801
10802 @kindex maint info symtabs
10803 @kindex maint info psymtabs
10804 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
10805 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10806 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10807 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10808 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10809 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10810
10811 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
10812 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
10813 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
10814 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
10815 structure in more detail. For example:
10816
10817 @smallexample
10818 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
10819 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10820 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10821 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10822 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
10823 readin no
10824 fullname (null)
10825 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
10826 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
10827 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
10828 dependencies (none)
10829 @}
10830 @}
10831 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10832 (@value{GDBP})
10833 @end smallexample
10834 @noindent
10835 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
10836 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
10837 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
10838 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
10839 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
10840
10841 @smallexample
10842 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
10843 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
10844 line 1574.
10845 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
10846 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10847 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10848 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10849 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
10850 dirname (null)
10851 fullname (null)
10852 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
10853 debugformat DWARF 2
10854 @}
10855 @}
10856 (@value{GDBP})
10857 @end smallexample
10858 @end table
10859
10860
10861 @node Altering
10862 @chapter Altering Execution
10863
10864 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
10865 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
10866 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
10867 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
10868 program.
10869
10870 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
10871 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
10872 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
10873
10874 @menu
10875 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
10876 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
10877 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
10878 * Returning:: Returning from a function
10879 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
10880 * Patching:: Patching your program
10881 @end menu
10882
10883 @node Assignment
10884 @section Assignment to variables
10885
10886 @cindex assignment
10887 @cindex setting variables
10888 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
10889 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
10890
10891 @smallexample
10892 print x=4
10893 @end smallexample
10894
10895 @noindent
10896 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
10897 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
10898 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
10899 information on operators in supported languages.
10900
10901 @kindex set variable
10902 @cindex variables, setting
10903 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
10904 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
10905 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
10906 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
10907 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
10908
10909 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
10910 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
10911 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
10912 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
10913 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
10914 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
10915 command @code{set width}:
10916
10917 @smallexample
10918 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
10919 type = double
10920 (@value{GDBP}) p width
10921 $4 = 13
10922 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
10923 Invalid syntax in expression.
10924 @end smallexample
10925
10926 @noindent
10927 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
10928 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
10932 @end smallexample
10933
10934 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
10935 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
10936 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
10937 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
10938 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
10939 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
10940
10941 @smallexample
10942 @group
10943 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
10944 type = double
10945 (@value{GDBP}) p g
10946 $1 = 1
10947 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
10948 (@value{GDBP}) p g
10949 $2 = 1
10950 (@value{GDBP}) r
10951 The program being debugged has been started already.
10952 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
10953 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
10954 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
10955 Invalid bfd target.
10956 (@value{GDBP}) show g
10957 The current BFD target is "=4".
10958 @end group
10959 @end smallexample
10960
10961 @noindent
10962 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
10963 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
10964 @code{g}, use
10965
10966 @smallexample
10967 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
10968 @end smallexample
10969
10970 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
10971 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
10972 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
10973 same length or shorter.
10974 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
10975 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
10976
10977 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
10978 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
10979 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
10980 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
10981 and representation in memory), and
10982
10983 @smallexample
10984 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
10985 @end smallexample
10986
10987 @noindent
10988 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
10989
10990 @node Jumping
10991 @section Continuing at a different address
10992
10993 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
10994 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
10995 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
10996
10997 @table @code
10998 @kindex jump
10999 @item jump @var{linespec}
11000 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11001 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11002 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11003 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11004 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11005 breakpoints}.
11006
11007 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11008 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11009 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11010 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11011 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11012 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11013 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11014 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11015 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11016
11017 @item jump *@var{address}
11018 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11019 @end table
11020
11021 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11022 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11023 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11024 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11025 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11026 example,
11027
11028 @smallexample
11029 set $pc = 0x485
11030 @end smallexample
11031
11032 @noindent
11033 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11034 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11035 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
11036
11037 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11038 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11039 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11040 detail.
11041
11042 @c @group
11043 @node Signaling
11044 @section Giving your program a signal
11045 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11046
11047 @table @code
11048 @kindex signal
11049 @item signal @var{signal}
11050 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11051 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11052 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11053 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11054
11055 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11056 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11057 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11058 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11059 signal.
11060
11061 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11062 after executing the command.
11063 @end table
11064 @c @end group
11065
11066 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11067 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11068 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11069 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11070 passes the signal directly to your program.
11071
11072
11073 @node Returning
11074 @section Returning from a function
11075
11076 @table @code
11077 @cindex returning from a function
11078 @kindex return
11079 @item return
11080 @itemx return @var{expression}
11081 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11082 command. If you give an
11083 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11084 value.
11085 @end table
11086
11087 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11088 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11089 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11090 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11091
11092 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11093 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11094 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11095 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11096 of functions.
11097
11098 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11099 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11100 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11101 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
11102 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11103
11104 @node Calling
11105 @section Calling program functions
11106
11107 @table @code
11108 @cindex calling functions
11109 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11110 @item print @var{expr}
11111 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
11112 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11113 debugged.
11114
11115 @kindex call
11116 @item call @var{expr}
11117 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11118 returned values.
11119
11120 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11121 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11122 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11123 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11124 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11125 value history.
11126 @end table
11127
11128 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11129 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11130 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11131 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11132
11133 @table @code
11134 @item set unwindonsignal
11135 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11136 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11137 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11138 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11139 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11140 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11141 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11142 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11143 received.
11144
11145 @item show unwindonsignal
11146 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11147 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11148 @value{GDBN}.
11149 @end table
11150
11151 @cindex weak alias functions
11152 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11153 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11154 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11155 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11156 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11157 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11158 function instead.
11159
11160 @node Patching
11161 @section Patching programs
11162
11163 @cindex patching binaries
11164 @cindex writing into executables
11165 @cindex writing into corefiles
11166
11167 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11168 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11169 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11170 patching your program's binary.
11171
11172 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11173 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11174 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11175 repairs.
11176
11177 @table @code
11178 @kindex set write
11179 @item set write on
11180 @itemx set write off
11181 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11182 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11183 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11184
11185 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11186 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11187 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11188
11189 @item show write
11190 @kindex show write
11191 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11192 as well as reading.
11193 @end table
11194
11195 @node GDB Files
11196 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11197
11198 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11199 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11200 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11201 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11202
11203 @menu
11204 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11205 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11206 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11207 @end menu
11208
11209 @node Files
11210 @section Commands to specify files
11211
11212 @cindex symbol table
11213 @cindex core dump file
11214
11215 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11216 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11217 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11218 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11219
11220 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11221 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11222 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11223 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
11224 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
11225
11226 @table @code
11227 @cindex executable file
11228 @kindex file
11229 @item file @var{filename}
11230 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11231 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11232 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11233 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11234 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11235 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11236 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11237 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11238
11239 @cindex unlinked object files
11240 @cindex patching object files
11241 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11242 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11243 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11244 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11245 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11246 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11247 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11248 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11249
11250 @item file
11251 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11252 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11253
11254 @kindex exec-file
11255 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11256 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11257 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11258 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11259 discard information on the executable file.
11260
11261 @kindex symbol-file
11262 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11263 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11264 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11265 table and program to run from the same file.
11266
11267 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11268 program's symbol table.
11269
11270 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11271 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11272 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11273 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11274 @value{GDBN}.
11275
11276 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11277 executing it once.
11278
11279 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11280 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11281 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11282 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11283 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11284 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11285 optimized code.
11286
11287 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11288 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11289 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11290 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11291 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11292
11293 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11294 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11295 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11296 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11297 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11298 warnings and messages}.)
11299
11300 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11301 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11302 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11303 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11304 in stabs format.
11305
11306 @kindex readnow
11307 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11308 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11309 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11310 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11311 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11312 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11313 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11314 entire symbol table available.
11315
11316 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11317 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11318 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11319 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11320 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11321 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11322 @c files.
11323
11324 @kindex core-file
11325 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11326 @itemx core
11327 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11328 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11329 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11330 executable file itself for other parts.
11331
11332 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11333 to be used.
11334
11335 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11336 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11337 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11338 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11339 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11340
11341 @kindex add-symbol-file
11342 @cindex dynamic linking
11343 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11344 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11345 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11346 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11347 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11348 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11349 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11350 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11351 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11352 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11353 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11354 @var{address} as an expression.
11355
11356 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11357 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11358 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11359 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11360 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11361
11362 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11363 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11364 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11365 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11366 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11367 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11368 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11369 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11370 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11371
11372 @itemize @bullet
11373 @item
11374 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11375 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11376 @item
11377 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11378 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11379 @item
11380 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11381 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11382 @end itemize
11383
11384 @noindent
11385 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11386 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11387 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11388 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11389 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11390 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11391 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11392 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11393 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11394 way.
11395
11396 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11397
11398 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11399 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11400 @cindex load symbols from memory
11401 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11402 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11403 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11404 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11405 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11406 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11407 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11408 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11409 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11410
11411 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11412 @kindex assf
11413 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11414 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11415 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11416 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11417 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11418 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11419 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11420 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11421 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11422 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11423
11424 @kindex section
11425 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11426 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11427 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11428 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11429 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11430 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11431 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11432 their addresses.
11433
11434 @kindex info files
11435 @kindex info target
11436 @item info files
11437 @itemx info target
11438 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11439 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11440 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11441 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11442 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11443 current ones.
11444
11445 @kindex maint info sections
11446 @item maint info sections
11447 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11448 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11449 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11450 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11451 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11452 may be arbitrarily combined):
11453
11454 @table @code
11455 @item ALLOBJ
11456 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11457 @item @var{sections}
11458 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11459 @item @var{section-flags}
11460 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11461 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11462 @table @code
11463 @item ALLOC
11464 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11465 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11466 @item LOAD
11467 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11468 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11469 @item RELOC
11470 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11471 @item READONLY
11472 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11473 @item CODE
11474 Section contains executable code only.
11475 @item DATA
11476 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11477 @item ROM
11478 Section will reside in ROM.
11479 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11480 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11481 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11482 Section is not empty.
11483 @item NEVER_LOAD
11484 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11485 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11486 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11487 COFF shared library information.
11488 @item IS_COMMON
11489 Section contains common symbols.
11490 @end table
11491 @end table
11492 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11493 @cindex read-only sections
11494 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11495 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11496 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11497 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11498 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11499 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11500 enhancement to debugging performance.
11501
11502 The default is off.
11503
11504 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11505 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11506 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11507 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11508
11509 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11510 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11511 @end table
11512
11513 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11514 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11515 name and remembers it that way.
11516
11517 @cindex shared libraries
11518 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11519 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11520
11521 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11522 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11523 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11524 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11525 debugging a core file).
11526
11527 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11528 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11529
11530 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11531 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11532 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11533
11534 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11535 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11536 particularly large or there are many of them.
11537
11538 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11539 commands:
11540
11541 @table @code
11542 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11543 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11544 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11545 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11546 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11547 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11548 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11549 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11550
11551 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11552 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11553 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11554 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11555 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11556 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11557 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11558 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11559 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11560
11561 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11562 @item show auto-solib-add
11563 Display the current autoloading mode.
11564 @end table
11565
11566 @cindex load shared library
11567 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11568 command:
11569
11570 @table @code
11571 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11572 @kindex info share
11573 @item info share
11574 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11575 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11576
11577 @kindex sharedlibrary
11578 @kindex share
11579 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11580 @itemx share @var{regex}
11581 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11582 Unix regular expression.
11583 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11584 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11585 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11586 loaded.
11587
11588 @item nosharedlibrary
11589 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11590 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11591 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11592 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11593 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11594 discarded.
11595 @end table
11596
11597 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11598 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11599 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11600
11601 @table @code
11602 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11603 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11604 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11605 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11606 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11607 shared library.
11608
11609 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11610 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11611 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11612 library events happen.
11613 @end table
11614
11615 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11616 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11617 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11618 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11619 not.
11620
11621 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11622 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11623 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11624 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11625 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11626
11627 @table @code
11628 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11629 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11630 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11631 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11632 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11633 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11634 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11635 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11636 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11637
11638 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11639 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11640 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11641 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11642
11643 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11644 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11645 Display the current shared library prefix.
11646
11647 @kindex set solib-search-path
11648 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11649 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11650 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11651 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11652 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11653 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11654 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11655 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11656
11657 @kindex show solib-search-path
11658 @item show solib-search-path
11659 Display the current shared library search path.
11660 @end table
11661
11662
11663 @node Separate Debug Files
11664 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11665 @cindex separate debugging information files
11666 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11667 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11668 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11669 @cindex global debugging information directory
11670
11671 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11672 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11673 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11674 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11675 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11676 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11677 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11678
11679 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11680 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11681 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11682 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11683 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11684 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11685 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11686 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11687 places:
11688
11689 @itemize @bullet
11690 @item
11691 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11692 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11693 @item
11694 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11695 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11696 @item
11697 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11698 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11699 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11700 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11701 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11702 @end itemize
11703 @noindent
11704 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11705 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11706 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11707
11708 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11709 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11710 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11711 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11712 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11713 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11714
11715 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11716 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11717
11718 @table @code
11719
11720 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11721 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11722 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11723 information files to @var{directory}.
11724
11725 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11726 @item show debug-file-directory
11727 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11728 information files.
11729
11730 @end table
11731
11732 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11733 @cindex debug links
11734 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11735 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11736
11737 @itemize
11738 @item
11739 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11740 a zero byte,
11741 @item
11742 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11743 boundary within the section, and
11744 @item
11745 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11746 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11747 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11748 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11749 @end itemize
11750
11751 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11752 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11753 described above.
11754
11755 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11756 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11757 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11758 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11759 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11760 in an ordinary executable.
11761
11762 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11763 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11764 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11765 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11766 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11767 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11768 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11769
11770 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11771 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11772 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11773 complete code for a function that computes it:
11774
11775 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11776 @smallexample
11777 unsigned long
11778 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11779 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11780 @{
11781 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11782 @{
11783 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11784 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
11785 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
11786 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
11787 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
11788 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
11789 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
11790 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
11791 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
11792 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
11793 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
11794 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
11795 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
11796 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
11797 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
11798 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
11799 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
11800 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
11801 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
11802 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
11803 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
11804 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
11805 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
11806 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
11807 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
11808 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
11809 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
11810 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
11811 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
11812 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
11813 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
11814 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
11815 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
11816 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
11817 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
11818 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
11819 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
11820 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
11821 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
11822 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
11823 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
11824 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
11825 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
11826 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
11827 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
11828 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
11829 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
11830 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
11831 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
11832 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
11833 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
11834 0x2d02ef8d
11835 @};
11836 unsigned char *end;
11837
11838 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11839 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
11840 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
11841 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
11842 @}
11843 @end smallexample
11844
11845
11846 @node Symbol Errors
11847 @section Errors reading symbol files
11848
11849 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
11850 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
11851 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
11852 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
11853 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
11854 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
11855 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
11856 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
11857 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
11858 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11859 messages}).
11860
11861 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
11862
11863 @table @code
11864 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
11865
11866 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
11867 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
11868 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
11869 in its outer scope blocks.
11870
11871 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
11872 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
11873 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
11874 function.
11875
11876 @item block at @var{address} out of order
11877
11878 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
11879 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
11880 do so.
11881
11882 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
11883 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
11884 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
11885 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
11886 messages}.)
11887
11888 @item bad block start address patched
11889
11890 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
11891 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
11892 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
11893
11894 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
11895 starting on the previous source line.
11896
11897 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
11898
11899 @cindex foo
11900 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
11901 larger than the size of the string table.
11902
11903 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
11904 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
11905 with this name.
11906
11907 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
11908
11909 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
11910 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
11911 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
11912
11913 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
11914 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
11915 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
11916 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
11917 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
11918 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
11919
11920 @item stub type has NULL name
11921
11922 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
11923
11924 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
11925 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
11926 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
11927 it.
11928
11929 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
11930
11931 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
11932
11933 @end table
11934
11935 @node Targets
11936 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
11937
11938 @cindex debugging target
11939 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
11940
11941 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
11942 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
11943 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
11944 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
11945 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
11946 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
11947 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
11948 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11949
11950 @cindex target architecture
11951 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
11952 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
11953 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
11954 command.
11955
11956 @table @code
11957 @kindex set architecture
11958 @kindex show architecture
11959 @item set architecture @var{arch}
11960 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
11961 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
11962 supported architectures.
11963
11964 @item show architecture
11965 Show the current target architecture.
11966
11967 @item set processor
11968 @itemx processor
11969 @kindex set processor
11970 @kindex show processor
11971 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
11972 and @code{show architecture}.
11973 @end table
11974
11975 @menu
11976 * Active Targets:: Active targets
11977 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
11978 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
11979 * Remote:: Remote debugging
11980
11981 @end menu
11982
11983 @node Active Targets
11984 @section Active targets
11985
11986 @cindex stacking targets
11987 @cindex active targets
11988 @cindex multiple targets
11989
11990 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
11991 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
11992 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
11993 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
11994 a core file.
11995
11996 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
11997 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
11998 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
11999 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12000 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12001 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12002 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12003 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12004 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12005
12006 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12007 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12008 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12009 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12010 process target is active.
12011
12012 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12013 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
12014 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12015 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
12016 process}).
12017
12018 @node Target Commands
12019 @section Commands for managing targets
12020
12021 @table @code
12022 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12023 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12024 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12025 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12026 protocol of the target machine.
12027
12028 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12029 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12030 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12031
12032 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12033 after executing the command.
12034
12035 @kindex help target
12036 @item help target
12037 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12038 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12039 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
12040
12041 @item help target @var{name}
12042 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12043 select it.
12044
12045 @kindex set gnutarget
12046 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12047 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12048 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12049 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12050 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12051 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12052
12053 @quotation
12054 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12055 you must know the actual BFD name.
12056 @end quotation
12057
12058 @noindent
12059 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
12060
12061 @kindex show gnutarget
12062 @item show gnutarget
12063 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12064 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12065 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12066 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12067 @end table
12068
12069 @cindex common targets
12070 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12071 configuration):
12072
12073 @table @code
12074 @kindex target
12075 @item target exec @var{program}
12076 @cindex executable file target
12077 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12078 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12079
12080 @item target core @var{filename}
12081 @cindex core dump file target
12082 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12083 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12084
12085 @item target remote @var{medium}
12086 @cindex remote target
12087 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12088 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12089 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12090
12091 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12092 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12093
12094 @smallexample
12095 target remote /dev/ttya
12096 @end smallexample
12097
12098 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12099 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12100 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12101 clobbered by the download.
12102
12103 @item target sim
12104 @cindex built-in simulator target
12105 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12106 In general,
12107 @smallexample
12108 target sim
12109 load
12110 run
12111 @end smallexample
12112 @noindent
12113 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12114 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12115 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12116 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12117 Processors}.
12118
12119 @end table
12120
12121 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12122
12123 @table @code
12124
12125 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12126 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12127 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12128
12129 @end table
12130
12131 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12132 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12133
12134 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12135 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12136 various aspects of this process, such as the size of the data chunks
12137 used by @value{GDBN} to download program parts to the remote target.
12138
12139 @table @code
12140 @kindex set download-write-size
12141 @item set download-write-size @var{size}
12142 Set the write size used when downloading a program. Only used when
12143 downloading a program onto a remote target. Specify zero or a
12144 negative value to disable blocked writes. The actual size of each
12145 transfer is also limited by the size of the target packet and the
12146 memory cache.
12147
12148 @kindex show download-write-size
12149 @item show download-write-size
12150 @kindex show download-write-size
12151 Show the current value of the write size.
12152
12153 @item set hash
12154 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12155 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12156 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12157 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12158 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12159 monitor.
12160
12161 @item show hash
12162 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12163 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12164
12165 @item set debug monitor
12166 @kindex set debug monitor
12167 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12168 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12169 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12170
12171 @item show debug monitor
12172 @kindex show debug monitor
12173 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12174 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12175 @end table
12176
12177 @table @code
12178
12179 @kindex load @var{filename}
12180 @item load @var{filename}
12181 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12182 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12183 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12184 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12185 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12186 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12187
12188 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12189 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12190 target is @dots{}}''
12191
12192 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12193 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12194 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12195 specifies a fixed address.
12196 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12197
12198 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12199 @end table
12200
12201 @node Byte Order
12202 @section Choosing target byte order
12203
12204 @cindex choosing target byte order
12205 @cindex target byte order
12206
12207 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12208 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12209 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12210 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12211 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12212 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12213
12214 @table @code
12215 @kindex set endian
12216 @item set endian big
12217 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12218
12219 @item set endian little
12220 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12221
12222 @item set endian auto
12223 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12224 executable.
12225
12226 @item show endian
12227 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12228
12229 @end table
12230
12231 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12232 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12233 target system.
12234
12235 @node Remote
12236 @section Remote debugging
12237 @cindex remote debugging
12238
12239 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12240 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12241 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12242 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12243 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12244
12245 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12246 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12247 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12248 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12249 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12250 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12251
12252 Other remote targets may be available in your
12253 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12254
12255 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12256 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12257
12258 @table @code
12259 @item remote @var{command}
12260 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12261 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12262 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12263 @end table
12264
12265
12266 @node Remote Debugging
12267 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12268
12269 @menu
12270 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12271 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12272 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12273 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12274 @end menu
12275
12276 @node Connecting
12277 @section Connecting to a remote target
12278
12279 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12280 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
12281 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12282 program as the first argument.
12283
12284 @cindex @code{target remote}
12285 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12286 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12287 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12288 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12289 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12290 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12291
12292 @table @code
12293
12294 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12295 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12296 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12297 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12298
12299 @smallexample
12300 target remote /dev/ttyb
12301 @end smallexample
12302
12303 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12304 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12305 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12306 @code{target} command.
12307
12308 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12309 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12310 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12311 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12312 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12313 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12314 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12315 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12316 target.
12317
12318 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12319 @code{manyfarms}:
12320
12321 @smallexample
12322 target remote manyfarms:2828
12323 @end smallexample
12324
12325 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12326 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12327 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12328 port 1234 on your local machine:
12329
12330 @smallexample
12331 target remote :1234
12332 @end smallexample
12333 @noindent
12334
12335 Note that the colon is still required here.
12336
12337 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12338 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12339 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12340 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12341
12342 @smallexample
12343 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12344 @end smallexample
12345
12346 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12347 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12348 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12349 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12350
12351 @item target remote | @var{command}
12352 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12353 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12354 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12355 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12356 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12357 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12358 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12359 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12360
12361 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12362 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12363 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12364
12365 @end table
12366
12367 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12368 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12369 remote program.
12370
12371 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12372 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12373 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12374 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12375 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12376 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12377 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12378
12379 @smallexample
12380 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12381 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12382 @end smallexample
12383
12384 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12385 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12386 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12387 goes back to waiting.
12388
12389 @table @code
12390 @kindex detach (remote)
12391 @item detach
12392 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12393 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12394 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12395 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12396 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12397
12398 @kindex disconnect
12399 @item disconnect
12400 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12401 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12402 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12403 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12404 another target.
12405
12406 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12407 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12408 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12409 @kindex monitor
12410 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12411 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12412 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12413 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12414 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12415 and implement.
12416 @end table
12417
12418 @node Server
12419 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12420
12421 @kindex gdbserver
12422 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12423 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12424 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12425 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12426
12427 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12428 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12429 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12430 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12431 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12432 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12433 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12434 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12435 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12436 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12437 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12438 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12439 choice for debugging.
12440
12441 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12442 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12443 protocol.
12444
12445 @table @emph
12446 @item On the target machine,
12447 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12448 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12449 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12450 system does all the symbol handling.
12451
12452 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12453 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12454 syntax is:
12455
12456 @smallexample
12457 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12458 @end smallexample
12459
12460 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12461 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12462 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12463 @file{/dev/com1}:
12464
12465 @smallexample
12466 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12467 @end smallexample
12468
12469 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12470 with it.
12471
12472 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12473
12474 @smallexample
12475 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12476 @end smallexample
12477
12478 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12479 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12480 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12481 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12482 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12483 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12484 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12485 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12486 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12487 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12488 @code{target remote} command.
12489
12490 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12491 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12492
12493 @smallexample
12494 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12495 @end smallexample
12496
12497 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12498 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12499
12500 @pindex pidof
12501 @cindex attach to a program by name
12502 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12503 @code{pidof} utility:
12504
12505 @smallexample
12506 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12507 @end smallexample
12508
12509 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12510 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12511 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12512
12513 @item On the host machine,
12514 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12515 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12516 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12517 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12518 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12519 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12520 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12521 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12522 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12523 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12524 program is considered running after the connection.
12525
12526 @end table
12527
12528 @node Remote configuration
12529 @section Remote configuration
12530
12531 @kindex set remote
12532 @kindex show remote
12533 This section documents the configuration options available when
12534 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12535 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12536 system-call-allowed}.
12537
12538 @table @code
12539 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12540 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12541 @cindex bits in remote address
12542 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12543 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12544 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12545 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12546
12547 @item show remoteaddresssize
12548 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12549
12550 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12551 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12552 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12553 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12554 remote targets.
12555
12556 @item show remotebaud
12557 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12558
12559 @item set remotebreak
12560 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12561 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12562 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12563 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12564 when you press the @key{Ctrl-C} key to interrupt the program running
12565 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12566 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12567 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12568
12569 @item show remotebreak
12570 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12571 interrupt the remote program.
12572
12573 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12574 @cindex serial port name
12575 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12576 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12577 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12578 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12579 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12580 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12581 arguments.)
12582
12583 @item show remotedevice
12584 Show the current name of the serial port.
12585
12586 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12587 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12588 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12589 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12590 @code{ascii}.
12591
12592 @item show remotelogbase
12593 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12594 protocol.
12595
12596 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12597 @cindex record serial communications on file
12598 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12599 default is not to record at all.
12600
12601 @item show remotelogfile.
12602 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12603 serial communications.
12604
12605 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12606 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12607 @cindex remote timeout
12608 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12609 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12610
12611 @item show remotetimeout
12612 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12613 responses.
12614
12615 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12616 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12617 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12618 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12619 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12620 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12621 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12622 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12623
12624 @item set remote fetch-register-packet
12625 @itemx set remote set-register-packet
12626 @itemx set remote P-packet
12627 @itemx set remote p-packet
12628 @cindex P-packet
12629 @cindex fetch registers from remote targets
12630 @cindex set registers in remote targets
12631 Determine whether @value{GDBN} can set and fetch registers from the
12632 remote target using the @samp{P} packets. The default depends on the
12633 remote stub's support of the @samp{P} packets (@value{GDBN} queries
12634 the stub when this packet is first required).
12635
12636 @item show remote fetch-register-packet
12637 @itemx show remote set-register-packet
12638 @itemx show remote P-packet
12639 @itemx show remote p-packet
12640 Show the current setting of using the @samp{P} packets for setting and
12641 fetching registers from the remote target.
12642
12643 @cindex binary downloads
12644 @cindex X-packet
12645 @item set remote binary-download-packet
12646 @itemx set remote X-packet
12647 Determine whether @value{GDBN} sends downloads in binary mode using
12648 the @samp{X} packets. The default is on.
12649
12650 @item show remote binary-download-packet
12651 @itemx show remote X-packet
12652 Show the current setting of using the @samp{X} packets for binary
12653 downloads.
12654
12655 @item set remote read-aux-vector-packet
12656 @cindex auxiliary vector of remote target
12657 @cindex @code{auxv}, and remote targets
12658 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} (target
12659 auxiliary vector) request. This request is used to fetch the
12660 remote target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}, see @ref{OS Information,
12661 Auxiliary Vector}. The default setting depends on the remote stub's
12662 support of this request (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this
12663 request is first required). @xref{General Query Packets, qXfer}, for
12664 more information about this request.
12665
12666 @item show remote read-aux-vector-packet
12667 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} request.
12668
12669 @item set remote symbol-lookup-packet
12670 @cindex remote symbol lookup request
12671 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{qSymbol} (target symbol
12672 lookup) request. This request is used to communicate symbol
12673 information to the remote target, e.g., whenever a new shared library
12674 is loaded by the remote (@pxref{Files, shared libraries}). The
12675 default setting depends on the remote stub's support of this request
12676 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when this request is first required).
12677 @xref{General Query Packets, qSymbol}, for more information about this
12678 request.
12679
12680 @item show remote symbol-lookup-packet
12681 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{qSymbol} request.
12682
12683 @item set remote verbose-resume-packet
12684 @cindex resume remote target
12685 @cindex signal thread, and remote targets
12686 @cindex single-step thread, and remote targets
12687 @cindex thread-specific operations on remote targets
12688 Set the use of the remote protocol's @samp{vCont} (descriptive resume)
12689 request. This request is used to resume specific threads in the
12690 remote target, and to single-step or signal them. The default setting
12691 depends on the remote stub's support of this request (@value{GDBN}
12692 queries the stub when this request is first required). This setting
12693 affects debugging of multithreaded programs: if @samp{vCont} cannot be
12694 used, @value{GDBN} might be unable to single-step a specific thread,
12695 especially under @code{set scheduler-locking off}; it is also
12696 impossible to pause a specific thread. @xref{Packets, vCont}, for
12697 more details.
12698
12699 @item show remote verbose-resume-packet
12700 Show the current setting of use of the @samp{vCont} request
12701
12702 @item set remote software-breakpoint-packet
12703 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12704 @itemx set remote write-watchpoint-packet
12705 @itemx set remote read-watchpoint-packet
12706 @itemx set remote access-watchpoint-packet
12707 @itemx set remote Z-packet
12708 @cindex Z-packet
12709 @cindex remote hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12710 These commands enable or disable the use of @samp{Z} packets for
12711 setting breakpoints and watchpoints in the remote target. The default
12712 depends on the remote stub's support of the @samp{Z} packets
12713 (@value{GDBN} queries the stub when each packet is first required).
12714 The command @code{set remote Z-packet}, kept for back-compatibility,
12715 turns on or off all the features that require the use of @samp{Z}
12716 packets.
12717
12718 @item show remote software-breakpoint-packet
12719 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-packet
12720 @itemx show remote write-watchpoint-packet
12721 @itemx show remote read-watchpoint-packet
12722 @itemx show remote access-watchpoint-packet
12723 @itemx show remote Z-packet
12724 Show the current setting of @samp{Z} packets usage.
12725
12726 @item set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12727 @kindex set remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12728 @cindex thread local storage of remote targets
12729 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qGetTLSAddr}
12730 (Get Thread Local Storage Address) request packet. The default
12731 depends on whether the remote stub supports this request.
12732 @xref{General Query Packets, qGetTLSAddr}, for more details about this
12733 packet.
12734
12735 @item show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12736 @kindex show remote get-thread-local-storage-address
12737 Show the current setting of @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet usage.
12738
12739 @item set remote supported-packets
12740 @kindex set remote supported-packets
12741 @cindex query supported packets of remote targets
12742 This command enables or disables the use of the @samp{qSupported}
12743 request packet. @xref{General Query Packets, qSupported}, for more
12744 details about this packet. The default is to use @samp{qSupported}.
12745
12746 @item show remote supported-packets
12747 @kindex show remote supported-packets
12748 Show the current setting of @samp{qSupported} packet usage.
12749 @end table
12750
12751 @node remote stub
12752 @section Implementing a remote stub
12753
12754 @cindex debugging stub, example
12755 @cindex remote stub, example
12756 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12757 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12758 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12759 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12760 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12761 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12762 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12763 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12764
12765 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12766 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12767 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12768 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12769 program, you need:
12770
12771 @enumerate
12772 @item
12773 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12774 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12775 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12776
12777 @item
12778 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12779 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12780
12781 @item
12782 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12783 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12784 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12785 documentation.
12786 @end enumerate
12787
12788 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12789 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12790 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12791
12792 @table @emph
12793 @item On the host,
12794 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12795 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12796 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12797
12798 @item On the target,
12799 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12800 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12801 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12802
12803 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12804 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12805 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12806 @end table
12807
12808 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12809 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12810 @sc{sparc} boards.
12811
12812 @cindex remote serial stub list
12813 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12814
12815 @table @code
12816
12817 @item i386-stub.c
12818 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12819 @cindex Intel
12820 @cindex i386
12821 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12822
12823 @item m68k-stub.c
12824 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12825 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12826 @cindex m680x0
12827 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12828
12829 @item sh-stub.c
12830 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12831 @cindex Renesas
12832 @cindex SH
12833 For Renesas SH architectures.
12834
12835 @item sparc-stub.c
12836 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12837 @cindex Sparc
12838 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12839
12840 @item sparcl-stub.c
12841 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
12842 @cindex Fujitsu
12843 @cindex SparcLite
12844 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
12845
12846 @end table
12847
12848 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
12849 recently added stubs.
12850
12851 @menu
12852 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
12853 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
12854 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
12855 @end menu
12856
12857 @node Stub Contents
12858 @subsection What the stub can do for you
12859
12860 @cindex remote serial stub
12861 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
12862 subroutines:
12863
12864 @table @code
12865 @item set_debug_traps
12866 @findex set_debug_traps
12867 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
12868 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
12869 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
12870 beginning of your program.
12871
12872 @item handle_exception
12873 @findex handle_exception
12874 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
12875 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
12876 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
12877 run when a trap is triggered.
12878
12879 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
12880 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
12881 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
12882 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
12883 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
12884 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
12885 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
12886 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
12887 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
12888 machine.
12889
12890 @item breakpoint
12891 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
12892 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
12893 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
12894 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
12895 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
12896 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
12897 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
12898 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
12899 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
12900 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
12901 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
12902
12903 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
12904 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
12905 start of your debugging session.
12906 @end table
12907
12908 @node Bootstrapping
12909 @subsection What you must do for the stub
12910
12911 @cindex remote stub, support routines
12912 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
12913 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
12914 debugging target machine.
12915
12916 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
12917 serial port.
12918
12919 @table @code
12920 @item int getDebugChar()
12921 @findex getDebugChar
12922 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
12923 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
12924 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
12925
12926 @item void putDebugChar(int)
12927 @findex putDebugChar
12928 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
12929 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
12930 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
12931 @end table
12932
12933 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
12934 @cindex interrupting remote targets
12935 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
12936 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
12937 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
12938 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
12939 remote system to stop.
12940
12941 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
12942 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
12943 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
12944 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
12945
12946 Other routines you need to supply are:
12947
12948 @table @code
12949 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
12950 @findex exceptionHandler
12951 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
12952 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
12953 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
12954 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
12955 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
12956 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
12957 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
12958 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
12959 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
12960 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
12961 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
12962 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
12963 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
12964
12965 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
12966 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
12967 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
12968 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
12969 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
12970
12971 @item void flush_i_cache()
12972 @findex flush_i_cache
12973 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
12974 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
12975 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
12976
12977 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
12978 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
12979 @end table
12980
12981 @noindent
12982 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
12983
12984 @table @code
12985 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
12986 @findex memset
12987 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
12988 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
12989 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
12990 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
12991 @end table
12992
12993 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
12994 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
12995 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
12996 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
12997
12998
12999 @node Debug Session
13000 @subsection Putting it all together
13001
13002 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13003 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13004 steps.
13005
13006 @enumerate
13007 @item
13008 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13009 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
13010 @display
13011 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13012 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13013 @end display
13014
13015 @item
13016 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13017
13018 @smallexample
13019 set_debug_traps();
13020 breakpoint();
13021 @end smallexample
13022
13023 @item
13024 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13025 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13026
13027 @smallexample
13028 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13029 @end smallexample
13030
13031 @noindent
13032 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13033 function in your program, that function is called when
13034 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13035 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13036 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13037
13038 @item
13039 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13040 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13041
13042 @item
13043 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13044 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13045
13046 @item
13047 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13048 @c document that. FIXME.
13049 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13050 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13051
13052 @item
13053 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13054 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
13055
13056 @end enumerate
13057
13058 @node Configurations
13059 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13060
13061 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13062 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13063 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13064
13065 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13066 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13067 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13068 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13069 are quite different from each other.
13070
13071 @menu
13072 * Native::
13073 * Embedded OS::
13074 * Embedded Processors::
13075 * Architectures::
13076 @end menu
13077
13078 @node Native
13079 @section Native
13080
13081 This section describes details specific to particular native
13082 configurations.
13083
13084 @menu
13085 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13086 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13087 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13088 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13089 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13090 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13091 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13092 @end menu
13093
13094 @node HP-UX
13095 @subsection HP-UX
13096
13097 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13098 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13099 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13100
13101
13102 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13103 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13104
13105 @cindex libkvm
13106 @cindex kernel memory image
13107 @cindex kernel crash dump
13108
13109 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13110 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13111 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13112 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13113 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13114 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13115 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13116 @code{kvm} target:
13117
13118 @smallexample
13119 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13120 @end smallexample
13121
13122 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13123 argument:
13124
13125 @smallexample
13126 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13127 @end smallexample
13128
13129 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13130 available:
13131
13132 @table @code
13133 @kindex kvm
13134 @item kvm pcb
13135 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13136
13137 @item kvm proc
13138 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13139 modern FreeBSD systems.
13140 @end table
13141
13142 @node SVR4 Process Information
13143 @subsection SVR4 process information
13144 @cindex /proc
13145 @cindex examine process image
13146 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13147
13148 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13149 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13150 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13151 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13152 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13153 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13154 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13155 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13156 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13157
13158 @table @code
13159 @kindex info proc
13160 @cindex process ID
13161 @item info proc
13162 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13163 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13164 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13165 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13166 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13167 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13168 executable file's absolute file name.
13169
13170 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13171 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13172 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13173 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13174 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13175 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13176
13177 @item info proc mappings
13178 @cindex memory address space mappings
13179 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13180 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13181 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13182 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13183 memory access rights to that range.
13184
13185 @item info proc stat
13186 @itemx info proc status
13187 @cindex process detailed status information
13188 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13189 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13190 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13191 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13192 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13193 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13194 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13195
13196 @item info proc all
13197 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13198 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13199
13200 @ignore
13201 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13202 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13203 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13204 @kindex info proc times
13205 @item info proc times
13206 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13207 its children.
13208
13209 @kindex info proc id
13210 @item info proc id
13211 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13212 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13213 @end ignore
13214
13215 @item set procfs-trace
13216 @kindex set procfs-trace
13217 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13218 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13219
13220 @item show procfs-trace
13221 @kindex show procfs-trace
13222 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13223
13224 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13225 @kindex set procfs-file
13226 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13227 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13228 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13229 standard output.
13230
13231 @item show procfs-file
13232 @kindex show procfs-file
13233 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13234
13235 @item proc-trace-entry
13236 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13237 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13238 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13239 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13240 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13241 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13242 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13243 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13244 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13245
13246 @item info pidlist
13247 @kindex info pidlist
13248 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13249 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13250 processes and all the threads within each process.
13251
13252 @item info meminfo
13253 @kindex info meminfo
13254 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13255 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13256 @end table
13257
13258 @node DJGPP Native
13259 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13260 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13261 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13262 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13263
13264 @cindex DPMI
13265 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13266 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13267 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13268 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13269
13270 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13271 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13272 subsection describes those commands.
13273
13274 @table @code
13275 @kindex info dos
13276 @item info dos
13277 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13278 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13279
13280 @kindex sysinfo
13281 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13282 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13283 @item info dos sysinfo
13284 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13285 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13286 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13287
13288 @cindex GDT
13289 @cindex LDT
13290 @cindex IDT
13291 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13292 @cindex descriptor tables display
13293 @item info dos gdt
13294 @itemx info dos ldt
13295 @itemx info dos idt
13296 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13297 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13298 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13299 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13300 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13301 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13302 rights.
13303
13304 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13305 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13306 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13307 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13308 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13309
13310 @cindex garbled pointers
13311 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13312 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13313 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13314 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13315 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13316 debugged program's data segment:
13317
13318 @smallexample
13319 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13320 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13321 @end smallexample
13322
13323 @noindent
13324 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13325 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13326
13327 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13328 @item info dos pde
13329 @itemx info dos pte
13330 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13331 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13332 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13333 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13334 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13335 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13336 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13337 that is currently in use.
13338
13339 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13340 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13341 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13342 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13343 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13344 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13345 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13346
13347 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13348 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13349 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13350 controller.
13351
13352 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13353
13354 @cindex physical address from linear address
13355 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13356 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13357 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13358 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13359 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13360 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13361 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13362
13363 @smallexample
13364 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13365 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13366 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13367 @end smallexample
13368
13369 @noindent
13370 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13371 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13372 attributes of that page.
13373
13374 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13375 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13376 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13377 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13378 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13379 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13380
13381 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13382 transfer buffer:
13383
13384 @smallexample
13385 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13386 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13387 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13388 @end smallexample
13389
13390 @noindent
13391 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13392 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13393 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13394 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13395 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13396
13397 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13398 @end table
13399
13400 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13401 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13402 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13403 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13404
13405 @table @code
13406 @kindex set com1base
13407 @kindex set com1irq
13408 @kindex set com2base
13409 @kindex set com2irq
13410 @kindex set com3base
13411 @kindex set com3irq
13412 @kindex set com4base
13413 @kindex set com4irq
13414 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13415 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13416 port.
13417
13418 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13419 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13420 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13421
13422 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13423 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13424 other 3 COM ports.
13425
13426 @kindex show com1base
13427 @kindex show com1irq
13428 @kindex show com2base
13429 @kindex show com2irq
13430 @kindex show com3base
13431 @kindex show com3irq
13432 @kindex show com4base
13433 @kindex show com4irq
13434 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13435 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13436 lines used by the COM ports.
13437
13438 @item info serial
13439 @kindex info serial
13440 @cindex DOS serial port status
13441 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13442 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13443 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13444 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13445 @end table
13446
13447
13448 @node Cygwin Native
13449 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13450 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13451 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13452 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13453
13454 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13455 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13456 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13457 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13458 that have no debugging symbols.
13459
13460
13461 @table @code
13462 @kindex info w32
13463 @item info w32
13464 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13465 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13466
13467 @item info w32 selector
13468 This command displays information returned by
13469 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13470 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13471 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13472 Without argument, this command displays information
13473 about the the six segment registers.
13474
13475 @kindex info dll
13476 @item info dll
13477 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13478
13479 @kindex dll-symbols
13480 @item dll-symbols
13481 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13482 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13483
13484 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13485 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13486 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13487 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13488 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13489 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13490 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13491 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13492 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13493 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13494 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13495
13496 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13497 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13498 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13499 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13500
13501 @kindex set new-console
13502 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13503 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13504 be started in a new console on next start.
13505 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13506 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13507
13508 @kindex show new-console
13509 @item show new-console
13510 Displays whether a new console is used
13511 when the debuggee is started.
13512
13513 @kindex set new-group
13514 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13515 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13516 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13517 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13518 Ctrl-C.
13519
13520 @kindex show new-group
13521 @item show new-group
13522 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13523
13524 @kindex set debugevents
13525 @item set debugevents
13526 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13527 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13528 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13529 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13530 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13531
13532 @kindex set debugexec
13533 @item set debugexec
13534 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13535 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13536
13537 @kindex set debugexceptions
13538 @item set debugexceptions
13539 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13540 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13541
13542 @kindex set debugmemory
13543 @item set debugmemory
13544 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13545 and writes by the debugger.
13546
13547 @kindex set shell
13548 @item set shell
13549 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13550 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13551
13552 @kindex show shell
13553 @item show shell
13554 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13555
13556 @end table
13557
13558 @menu
13559 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13560 @end menu
13561
13562 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13563 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13564 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13565 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13566
13567 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13568 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13569 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13570 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13571 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13572 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13573 ``minimal symbols''.
13574
13575 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13576 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13577 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13578 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13579 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13580 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13581 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13582 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13583 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13584 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13585
13586 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13587
13588 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13589 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13590 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13591 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13592 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13593 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13594 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13595 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13596 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13597
13598 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13599 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13600 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13601 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13602 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13603 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13604
13605 @smallexample
13606 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13607 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13608
13609 Non-debugging symbols:
13610 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13611 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13612 @end smallexample
13613
13614 @smallexample
13615 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13616 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13617
13618 Non-debugging symbols:
13619 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13620 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13621 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13622 [etc...]
13623 @end smallexample
13624
13625 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13626
13627 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13628 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13629 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13630 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13631 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13632 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13633 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13634
13635 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13636 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13637 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13638 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13639 problem:
13640
13641 @smallexample
13642 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13643 $1 = 268572168
13644 @end smallexample
13645
13646 @smallexample
13647 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13648 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13649 @end smallexample
13650
13651 And two possible solutions:
13652
13653 @smallexample
13654 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13655 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13656 @end smallexample
13657
13658 @smallexample
13659 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13660 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13661 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13662 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13663 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13664 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13665 @end smallexample
13666
13667 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13668 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13669 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13670 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13671 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13672
13673 @smallexample
13674 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13675 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13676 @end smallexample
13677
13678 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13679 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13680 safe.
13681
13682 @node Hurd Native
13683 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13684 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13685
13686 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13687 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13688
13689 @table @code
13690 @item set signals
13691 @itemx set sigs
13692 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13693 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13694 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13695 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13696 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13697 @code{signals}.
13698
13699 @item show signals
13700 @itemx show sigs
13701 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13702 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13703 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13704
13705 @item set signal-thread
13706 @itemx set sigthread
13707 @kindex set signal-thread
13708 @kindex set sigthread
13709 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13710 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13711 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13712 signal-thread}.
13713
13714 @item show signal-thread
13715 @itemx show sigthread
13716 @kindex show signal-thread
13717 @kindex show sigthread
13718 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13719 delivered a signal.
13720
13721 @item set stopped
13722 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13723 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13724 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13725 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13726
13727 @item show stopped
13728 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13729 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13730 stopped.
13731
13732 @item set exceptions
13733 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13734 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13735 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13736 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13737 trapping on.
13738
13739 @item show exceptions
13740 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13741 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13742
13743 @item set task pause
13744 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13745 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13746 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13747 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13748 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13749 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13750 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13751 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13752 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13753
13754 @item show task pause
13755 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13756 Show the current state of task suspension.
13757
13758 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13759 @cindex task suspend count
13760 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13761 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13762 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13763
13764 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13765 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13766
13767 @item set task exception-port
13768 @itemx set task excp
13769 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13770 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13771 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13772 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13773
13774 @item set noninvasive
13775 @cindex noninvasive task options
13776 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13777 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13778 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13779 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13780
13781 @item info send-rights
13782 @itemx info receive-rights
13783 @itemx info port-rights
13784 @itemx info port-sets
13785 @itemx info dead-names
13786 @itemx info ports
13787 @itemx info psets
13788 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13789 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13790 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13791 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13792 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13793 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13794 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13795 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13796 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13797
13798 @item set thread pause
13799 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13800 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13801 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13802 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13803 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13804 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13805 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13806 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13807 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13808 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13809 only the current thread.
13810
13811 @item show thread pause
13812 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13813 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13814
13815 @item set thread run
13816 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13817
13818 @item show thread run
13819 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13820
13821 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13822 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13823 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13824 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13825 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13826 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13827 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13828
13829 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13830 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13831 detaching.
13832
13833 @item set thread exception-port
13834 @itemx set thread excp
13835 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13836 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13837 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13838
13839 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
13840 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
13841 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
13842 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
13843
13844 @item set thread default
13845 @itemx show thread default
13846 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13847 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
13848 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
13849 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
13850 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
13851 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
13852 the non-default commands.
13853 @end table
13854
13855
13856 @node Neutrino
13857 @subsection QNX Neutrino
13858 @cindex QNX Neutrino
13859
13860 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
13861 Neutrino target:
13862
13863 @table @code
13864 @item set debug nto-debug
13865 @kindex set debug nto-debug
13866 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
13867 Neutrino support.
13868
13869 @item show debug nto-debug
13870 @kindex show debug nto-debug
13871 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
13872 @end table
13873
13874
13875 @node Embedded OS
13876 @section Embedded Operating Systems
13877
13878 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
13879 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
13880 architectures.
13881
13882 @menu
13883 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13884 @end menu
13885
13886 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
13887 various real-time operating systems.
13888
13889 @node VxWorks
13890 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
13891
13892 @cindex VxWorks
13893
13894 @table @code
13895
13896 @kindex target vxworks
13897 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
13898 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
13899 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
13900
13901 @end table
13902
13903 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
13904 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
13905
13906 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
13907 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
13908 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
13909 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
13910 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
13911 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
13912 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
13913
13914 @table @code
13915 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
13916 @kindex vxworks-timeout
13917 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
13918 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
13919 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
13920 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
13921 of a thin network line.
13922 @end table
13923
13924 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
13925 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
13926 procedures.
13927
13928 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
13929 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
13930 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
13931 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
13932 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
13933 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
13934 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
13935 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
13936 manual.
13937 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
13938
13939 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
13940 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
13941 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
13942 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
13943
13944 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
13945
13946 @smallexample
13947 (vxgdb)
13948 @end smallexample
13949
13950 @menu
13951 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
13952 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
13953 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
13954 @end menu
13955
13956 @node VxWorks Connection
13957 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
13958
13959 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
13960 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
13961
13962 @smallexample
13963 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
13964 @end smallexample
13965
13966 @need 750
13967 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
13968
13969 @smallexample
13970 Attaching remote machine across net...
13971 Connected to tt.
13972 @end smallexample
13973
13974 @need 1000
13975 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
13976 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
13977 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
13978 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
13979 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
13980
13981 @smallexample
13982 prog.o: No such file or directory.
13983 @end smallexample
13984
13985 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
13986 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
13987 command again.
13988
13989 @node VxWorks Download
13990 @subsubsection VxWorks download
13991
13992 @cindex download to VxWorks
13993 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
13994 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
13995 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
13996 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
13997 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
13998 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
13999 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14000 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14001 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14002 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14003 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14004 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14005 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14006 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14007 program, type this on VxWorks:
14008
14009 @smallexample
14010 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14011 @end smallexample
14012
14013 @noindent
14014 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14015
14016 @smallexample
14017 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14018 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14019 @end smallexample
14020
14021 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14022
14023 @smallexample
14024 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14025 @end smallexample
14026
14027 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14028 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14029 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14030 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14031 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14032 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14033 table.)
14034
14035 @node VxWorks Attach
14036 @subsubsection Running tasks
14037
14038 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14039 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14040 follows:
14041
14042 @smallexample
14043 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14044 @end smallexample
14045
14046 @noindent
14047 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14048 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14049 the time of attachment.
14050
14051 @node Embedded Processors
14052 @section Embedded Processors
14053
14054 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14055 configurations.
14056
14057 @cindex send command to simulator
14058 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14059 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14060
14061 @table @code
14062 @item sim @var{command}
14063 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14064 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14065 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14066 acceptable commands.
14067 @end table
14068
14069
14070 @menu
14071 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14072 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
14073 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
14074 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14075 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14076 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14077 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14078 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14079 * PowerPC: PowerPC
14080 * SH:: Renesas SH
14081 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14082 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14083 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
14084 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14085 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14086 * CRIS:: CRIS
14087 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14088 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
14089 @end menu
14090
14091 @node ARM
14092 @subsection ARM
14093 @cindex ARM RDI
14094
14095 @table @code
14096 @kindex target rdi
14097 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14098 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14099 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14100 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14101
14102 @kindex target rdp
14103 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14104 ARM Demon monitor.
14105
14106 @end table
14107
14108 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14109
14110 @table @code
14111 @item set arm disassembler
14112 @kindex set arm
14113 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14114 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14115
14116 @item show arm disassembler
14117 @kindex show arm
14118 Show the current disassembly style.
14119
14120 @item set arm apcs32
14121 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14122 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14123
14124 @item show arm apcs32
14125 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14126
14127 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14128 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14129 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14130
14131 @table @code
14132 @item auto
14133 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14134 @item softfpa
14135 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14136 processors.
14137 @item fpa
14138 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14139 @item softvfp
14140 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14141 @item vfp
14142 VFP co-processor.
14143 @end table
14144
14145 @item show arm fpu
14146 Show the current type of the FPU.
14147
14148 @item set arm abi
14149 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14150
14151 @item show arm abi
14152 Show the currently used ABI.
14153
14154 @item set debug arm
14155 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14156 target support subsystem.
14157
14158 @item show debug arm
14159 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14160 @end table
14161
14162 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14163 using the RDI interface:
14164
14165 @table @code
14166 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14167 @kindex rdilogfile
14168 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14169 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14170 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14171 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14172 @file{rdi.log}.
14173
14174 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14175 @kindex rdilogenable
14176 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14177 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14178 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14179 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14180 are logged to a file.
14181
14182 @item set rdiromatzero
14183 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14184 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14185 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14186 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14187 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14188 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14189
14190 @item show rdiromatzero
14191 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14192 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14193
14194 @item set rdiheartbeat
14195 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14196 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14197 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14198 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14199 well as the Angel monitor.
14200
14201 @item show rdiheartbeat
14202 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14203 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14204 @end table
14205
14206
14207 @node H8/300
14208 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14209
14210 @table @code
14211
14212 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14213 @item target hms @var{dev}
14214 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14215 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14216 line and the communications speed used.
14217
14218 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14219 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14220 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14221
14222 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14223 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14224 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14225 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14226 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14227
14228 @end table
14229
14230 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14231 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14232 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14233 @cindex Renesas SH download
14234 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14235 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14236 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14237 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14238
14239 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14240 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14241
14242 @enumerate
14243 @item
14244 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14245 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14246 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14247 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14248 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14249
14250 @item
14251 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14252 serial device available on your host is the default).
14253
14254 @item
14255 what speed to use over the serial device.
14256 @end enumerate
14257
14258 @menu
14259 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14260 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14261 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14262 @end menu
14263
14264 @node Renesas Boards
14265 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14266
14267 @c only for Unix hosts
14268 @kindex device
14269 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14270 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14271 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14272 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14273 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14274
14275 @kindex speed
14276 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14277 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14278 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14279 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14280 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14281 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14282
14283 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14284 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14285 use a DOS host,
14286 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14287 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14288 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14289 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14290
14291 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14292 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14293 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14294 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14295
14296 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14297 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14298 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14299 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14300 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14301 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14302 @code{COM2}.
14303
14304 @smallexample
14305 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14306 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14307
14308 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14309
14310 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14311
14312 @end smallexample
14313
14314 @quotation
14315 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14316 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14317 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14318 your development board.
14319 @end quotation
14320
14321 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14322 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14323 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14324 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14325 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14326 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14327 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14328 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14329 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14330 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14331 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14332 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14333 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14334
14335 @smallexample
14336 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14337 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14338 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14339 the conditions.
14340 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14341 for details.
14342 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14343 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14344 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14345 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14346 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14347 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14348 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14349 @end smallexample
14350
14351 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14352 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14353 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14354 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14355 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14356 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14357
14358 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14359 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14360 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14361
14362 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14363 @itemize @bullet
14364 @item
14365 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
14366 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14367
14368 @item
14369 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14370 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14371 to detect program completion.
14372 @end itemize
14373
14374 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14375 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14376
14377 @node Renesas ICE
14378 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14379
14380 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14381 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14382 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14383 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14384
14385 @table @code
14386 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14387 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14388 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14389 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14390 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14391
14392 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14393 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14394 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14395 @end table
14396
14397 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14398 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14399
14400 @table @code
14401 @item e7000 @var{command}
14402 @kindex e7000
14403 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14404 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14405
14406 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14407 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14408 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14409 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14410 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14411 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14412
14413 @item ftpload @var{file}
14414 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14415 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14416 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14417
14418 @item drain
14419 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14420 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14421
14422 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14423 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14424 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14425 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14426 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14427 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14428 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14429 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14430 @end table
14431
14432 @node Renesas Special
14433 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14434
14435 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14436
14437 @table @code
14438
14439 @kindex set machine
14440 @kindex show machine
14441 @item set machine h8300
14442 @itemx set machine h8300h
14443 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14444 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14445 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14446
14447 @end table
14448
14449 @node H8/500
14450 @subsection H8/500
14451
14452 @table @code
14453
14454 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14455 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14456 @item set memory @var{mod}
14457 @itemx show memory
14458 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14459 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14460 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14461 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14462
14463 @end table
14464
14465 @node M32R/D
14466 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14467
14468 @table @code
14469 @kindex target m32r
14470 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14471 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14472
14473 @kindex target m32rsdi
14474 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14475 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14476 @end table
14477
14478 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14479
14480 @table @code
14481 @item set download-path @var{path}
14482 @kindex set download-path
14483 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14484 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14485
14486 @item show download-path
14487 @kindex show download-path
14488 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14489
14490 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14491 @kindex set board-address
14492 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14493 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14494
14495 @item show board-address
14496 @kindex show board-address
14497 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14498
14499 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14500 @kindex set server-address
14501 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14502 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14503 host machine.
14504
14505 @item show server-address
14506 @kindex show server-address
14507 Display the IP address of the download server.
14508
14509 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14510 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14511 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14512 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14513 executable file is uploaded.
14514
14515 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14516 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14517 Test the @code{upload} command.
14518 @end table
14519
14520 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14521
14522 @table @code
14523 @item sdireset
14524 @kindex sdireset
14525 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14526 This command resets the SDI connection.
14527
14528 @item sdistatus
14529 @kindex sdistatus
14530 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14531
14532 @item debug_chaos
14533 @kindex debug_chaos
14534 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14535 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14536
14537 @item use_debug_dma
14538 @kindex use_debug_dma
14539 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14540
14541 @item use_mon_code
14542 @kindex use_mon_code
14543 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14544
14545 @item use_ib_break
14546 @kindex use_ib_break
14547 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14548
14549 @item use_dbt_break
14550 @kindex use_dbt_break
14551 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14552 @end table
14553
14554 @node M68K
14555 @subsection M68k
14556
14557 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14558 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14559
14560 @table @code
14561
14562 @kindex target abug
14563 @item target abug @var{dev}
14564 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14565
14566 @kindex target cpu32bug
14567 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14568 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14569
14570 @kindex target dbug
14571 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14572 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14573
14574 @kindex target est
14575 @item target est @var{dev}
14576 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14577
14578 @kindex target rom68k
14579 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14580 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14581
14582 @end table
14583
14584 @table @code
14585
14586 @kindex target rombug
14587 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14588 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14589
14590 @end table
14591
14592 @node MIPS Embedded
14593 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14594
14595 @cindex MIPS boards
14596 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14597 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14598 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14599
14600 @need 1000
14601 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14602
14603 @table @code
14604 @item target mips @var{port}
14605 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14606 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14607 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14608 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14609 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14610 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14611 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14612
14613 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14614 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14615 debugger:
14616
14617 @smallexample
14618 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14619 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14620 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14621 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14622 (@value{GDBP}) run
14623 @end smallexample
14624
14625 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14626 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14627 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14628 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14629 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14630
14631 @item target pmon @var{port}
14632 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14633 PMON ROM monitor.
14634
14635 @item target ddb @var{port}
14636 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14637 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14638
14639 @item target lsi @var{port}
14640 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14641 LSI variant of PMON.
14642
14643 @kindex target r3900
14644 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14645 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14646
14647 @kindex target array
14648 @item target array @var{dev}
14649 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14650
14651 @end table
14652
14653
14654 @noindent
14655 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14656
14657 @table @code
14658 @item set mipsfpu double
14659 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14660 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14661 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14662 @itemx show mipsfpu
14663 @kindex set mipsfpu
14664 @kindex show mipsfpu
14665 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14666 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14667 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14668 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14669 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14670 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14671 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14672 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14673 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14674 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14675 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14676 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14677 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14678
14679 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14680 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14681 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14682
14683 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14684 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14685
14686 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14687 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14688 @itemx show timeout
14689 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14690 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14691 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14692 @kindex set timeout
14693 @kindex show timeout
14694 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14695 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14696 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14697 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14698 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14699 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14700 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14701 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14702 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14703 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14704
14705 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14706 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14707 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14708 to run before stopping.
14709
14710 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14711 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14712 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14713 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14714 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14715 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14716
14717 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14718 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14719 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14720 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14721
14722 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14723 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14724 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14725 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14726 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14727 @table @asis
14728 @item pmon target
14729 @samp{PMON}
14730 @item ddb target
14731 @samp{NEC010}
14732 @item lsi target
14733 @samp{PMON>}
14734 @end table
14735
14736 @item show monitor-prompt
14737 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14738 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14739 remote monitor.
14740
14741 @item set monitor-warnings
14742 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14743 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14744 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14745 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14746 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14747
14748 @item show monitor-warnings
14749 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14750 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14751
14752 @item pmon @var{command}
14753 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14754 @cindex send PMON command
14755 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14756 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14757 @end table
14758
14759 @node OpenRISC 1000
14760 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14761 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14762
14763 @cindex or1k boards
14764 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14765 about platform and commands.
14766
14767 @table @code
14768
14769 @kindex target jtag
14770 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14771
14772 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14773 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14774 connected via parallel port to the board.
14775
14776 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14777
14778 @kindex or1ksim
14779 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14780 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14781 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14782
14783 @kindex info or1k spr
14784 @item info or1k spr
14785 Displays spr groups.
14786
14787 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14788 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14789 Displays register names in selected group.
14790
14791 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14792 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14793 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14794 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14795 Shows information about specified spr register.
14796
14797 @kindex spr
14798 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14799 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14800 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14801 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14802 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14803 @end table
14804
14805 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14806 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14807 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14808 triggers can be set using:
14809 @table @code
14810 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14811 Load effective address/data
14812 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14813 Store effective address/data
14814 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14815 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14816 @item $FETCH
14817 Fetch data
14818 @end table
14819
14820 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14821 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14822
14823 @code{htrace} commands:
14824 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14825 @table @code
14826 @kindex hwatch
14827 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14828 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14829 or Data. For example:
14830
14831 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14832
14833 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14834
14835 @kindex htrace
14836 @item htrace info
14837 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14838
14839 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14840 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14841
14842 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14843 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14844
14845 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14846 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14847
14848 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14849 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14850 triggered.
14851
14852 @item htrace enable
14853 @itemx htrace disable
14854 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14855
14856 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14857 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14858
14859 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14860 will be written there.
14861
14862 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14863 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14864
14865 @item htrace mode continuous
14866 Set continuous trace mode.
14867
14868 @item htrace mode suspend
14869 Set suspend trace mode.
14870
14871 @end table
14872
14873 @node PowerPC
14874 @subsection PowerPC
14875
14876 @table @code
14877 @kindex target dink32
14878 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14879 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14880
14881 @kindex target ppcbug
14882 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14883 @kindex target ppcbug1
14884 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14885 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14886
14887 @kindex target sds
14888 @item target sds @var{dev}
14889 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14890 @end table
14891
14892 @cindex SDS protocol
14893 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
14894 by@value{GDBN}:
14895
14896 @table @code
14897 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14898 @kindex set sdstimeout
14899 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14900 default is 2 seconds.
14901
14902 @item show sdstimeout
14903 @kindex show sdstimeout
14904 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14905
14906 @item sds @var{command}
14907 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
14908 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14909 @end table
14910
14911
14912 @node PA
14913 @subsection HP PA Embedded
14914
14915 @table @code
14916
14917 @kindex target op50n
14918 @item target op50n @var{dev}
14919 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14920
14921 @kindex target w89k
14922 @item target w89k @var{dev}
14923 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14924
14925 @end table
14926
14927 @node SH
14928 @subsection Renesas SH
14929
14930 @table @code
14931
14932 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
14933 @item target hms @var{dev}
14934 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
14935 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
14936 the communications speed used.
14937
14938 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
14939 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14940 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
14941
14942 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
14943 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
14944 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14945 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
14946 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14947
14948 @end table
14949
14950 @node Sparclet
14951 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14952
14953 @cindex Sparclet
14954
14955 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14956 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14957 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14958 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14959 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14960
14961 @table @code
14962 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
14963 @kindex remotetimeout
14964 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14965 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14966 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
14967 @end table
14968
14969 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
14970 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
14971 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
14972 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
14973 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
14974
14975 @smallexample
14976 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
14977 @end smallexample
14978
14979 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
14980
14981 @smallexample
14982 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
14983 @end smallexample
14984
14985 @cindex running, on Sparclet
14986 Once you have set
14987 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14988 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
14989 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
14990
14991 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14992
14993 @smallexample
14994 (gdbslet)
14995 @end smallexample
14996
14997 @menu
14998 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
14999 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15000 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15001 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15002 @end menu
15003
15004 @node Sparclet File
15005 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
15006
15007 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15008
15009 @smallexample
15010 (gdbslet) file prog
15011 @end smallexample
15012
15013 @need 1000
15014 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15015 @value{GDBN} locates
15016 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15017 path.
15018 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
15019 files will be searched as well.
15020 @value{GDBN} locates
15021 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15022 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
15023 If it fails
15024 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15025
15026 @smallexample
15027 prog: No such file or directory.
15028 @end smallexample
15029
15030 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15031 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15032 @code{target} command again.
15033
15034 @node Sparclet Connection
15035 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15036
15037 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15038 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15039
15040 @smallexample
15041 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15042 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15043 main () at ../prog.c:3
15044 @end smallexample
15045
15046 @need 750
15047 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15048
15049 @smallexample
15050 Connected to ttya.
15051 @end smallexample
15052
15053 @node Sparclet Download
15054 @subsubsection Sparclet download
15055
15056 @cindex download to Sparclet
15057 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15058 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15059 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15060 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15061 command.
15062 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15063 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15064 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15065 of each of the file's sections.
15066 For instance, if the program
15067 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15068 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15069
15070 @smallexample
15071 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15072 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15073 @end smallexample
15074
15075 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15076 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15077 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15078
15079 @node Sparclet Execution
15080 @subsubsection Running and debugging
15081
15082 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15083 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15084 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15085 manual for the list of commands.
15086
15087 @smallexample
15088 (gdbslet) b main
15089 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15090 (gdbslet) run
15091 Starting program: prog
15092 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15093 3 char *symarg = 0;
15094 (gdbslet) step
15095 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15096 (gdbslet)
15097 @end smallexample
15098
15099 @node Sparclite
15100 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15101
15102 @table @code
15103
15104 @kindex target sparclite
15105 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15106 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15107 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15108 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15109 remote protocol.
15110
15111 @end table
15112
15113 @node ST2000
15114 @subsection Tandem ST2000
15115
15116 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
15117 STDBUG protocol.
15118
15119 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
15120 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
15121
15122 @smallexample
15123 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
15124 @end smallexample
15125
15126 @noindent
15127 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
15128 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
15129 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
15130 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
15131 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15132
15133 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
15134 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
15135 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
15136 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
15137 available on your host computer.
15138 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
15139 @c basically hearsay.
15140
15141 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
15142 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
15143 environment:
15144
15145 @table @code
15146 @item st2000 @var{command}
15147 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15148 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15149 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15150 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15151 manual for available commands.
15152
15153 @item connect
15154 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15155 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15156 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15157 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15158 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15159 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15160 @end table
15161
15162 @node Z8000
15163 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15164
15165 @cindex Z8000
15166 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15167 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15168
15169 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15170 a Z8000 simulator.
15171
15172 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15173 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15174 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15175 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15176
15177 @table @code
15178 @item target sim @var{args}
15179 @kindex sim
15180 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15181 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15182 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15183 @end table
15184
15185 @noindent
15186 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15187 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15188 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15189 to run your program, and so on.
15190
15191 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15192 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15193 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15194
15195 @table @code
15196
15197 @item cycles
15198 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15199
15200 @item insts
15201 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15202
15203 @item time
15204 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15205
15206 @end table
15207
15208 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15209 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15210 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15211 simulated clock ticks.
15212
15213 @node AVR
15214 @subsection Atmel AVR
15215 @cindex AVR
15216
15217 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15218 following AVR-specific commands:
15219
15220 @table @code
15221 @item info io_registers
15222 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15223 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15224 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15225 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15226 @end table
15227
15228 @node CRIS
15229 @subsection CRIS
15230 @cindex CRIS
15231
15232 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15233 following CRIS-specific commands:
15234
15235 @table @code
15236 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15237 @cindex CRIS version
15238 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15239 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15240 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15241
15242 @item show cris-version
15243 Show the current CRIS version.
15244
15245 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15246 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15247 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15248 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15249 @code{R59}.
15250
15251 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15252 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15253
15254 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15255 @cindex CRIS mode
15256 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15257 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15258 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15259
15260 @item show cris-mode
15261 Show the current CRIS mode.
15262 @end table
15263
15264 @node Super-H
15265 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15266 @cindex Super-H
15267
15268 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15269 commands:
15270
15271 @table @code
15272 @item regs
15273 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15274 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15275 @end table
15276
15277 @node WinCE
15278 @subsection Windows CE
15279 @cindex Windows CE
15280
15281 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15282
15283 @table @code
15284 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15285 @kindex set remotedirectory
15286 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15287 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15288 drive.
15289
15290 @item show remotedirectory
15291 @kindex show remotedirectory
15292 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15293
15294 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15295 @kindex set remoteupload
15296 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15297 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15298 The default is @samp{newer}.
15299
15300 @item show remoteupload
15301 @kindex show remoteupload
15302 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15303
15304 @item set remoteaddhost
15305 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15306 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15307 arguments when you debug over a network.
15308
15309 @item show remoteaddhost
15310 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15311 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15312 debugging over a network.
15313 @end table
15314
15315
15316 @node Architectures
15317 @section Architectures
15318
15319 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15320 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15321
15322 @menu
15323 * i386::
15324 * A29K::
15325 * Alpha::
15326 * MIPS::
15327 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15328 @end menu
15329
15330 @node i386
15331 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15332
15333 @table @code
15334 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15335 @kindex set struct-convention
15336 @cindex struct return convention
15337 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15338 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15339 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15340 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15341 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15342 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15343 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15344 be returned in a register.
15345
15346 @item show struct-convention
15347 @kindex show struct-convention
15348 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15349 from functions.
15350 @end table
15351
15352 @node A29K
15353 @subsection A29K
15354
15355 @table @code
15356
15357 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15358 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15359 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15360 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15361 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15362 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15363 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15364 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15365 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15366 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15367 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15368 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15369 hexadecimal.
15370
15371 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15372 @item show rstack_high_address
15373 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15374 processors.
15375
15376 @end table
15377
15378 @node Alpha
15379 @subsection Alpha
15380
15381 See the following section.
15382
15383 @node MIPS
15384 @subsection MIPS
15385
15386 @cindex stack on Alpha
15387 @cindex stack on MIPS
15388 @cindex Alpha stack
15389 @cindex MIPS stack
15390 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15391 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15392 find the beginning of a function.
15393
15394 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15395 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15396 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15397 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15398 commands:
15399
15400 @table @code
15401 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15402 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15403 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15404 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15405 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15406 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15407 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15408 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15409
15410 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15411 Display the current limit.
15412 @end table
15413
15414 @noindent
15415 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15416 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15417
15418 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15419 programs:
15420
15421 @table @code
15422 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15423 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15424 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15425 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15426 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15427
15428 @table @samp
15429 @item 32
15430 32-bit GP registers
15431 @item 64
15432 64-bit GP registers
15433 @item auto
15434 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15435 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15436 @end table
15437
15438 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15439 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15440 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15441
15442 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15443 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15444 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15445 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15446 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15447 (the default).
15448
15449 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15450 @kindex set mips abi
15451 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15452 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15453 values of @var{arg} are:
15454
15455 @table @samp
15456 @item auto
15457 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15458 default).
15459 @item o32
15460 @item o64
15461 @item n32
15462 @item n64
15463 @item eabi32
15464 @item eabi64
15465 @item auto
15466 @end table
15467
15468 @item show mips abi
15469 @kindex show mips abi
15470 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15471
15472 @item set mipsfpu
15473 @itemx show mipsfpu
15474 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15475
15476 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15477 @kindex set mips mask-address
15478 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15479 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15480 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15481 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15482 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15483
15484 @item show mips mask-address
15485 @kindex show mips mask-address
15486 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15487 not.
15488
15489 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15490 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15491 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15492 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15493 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15494 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15495
15496 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15497 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15498 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15499
15500 @item set debug mips
15501 @kindex set debug mips
15502 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15503 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15504
15505 @item show debug mips
15506 @kindex show debug mips
15507 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15508 @end table
15509
15510
15511 @node HPPA
15512 @subsection HPPA
15513 @cindex HPPA support
15514
15515 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15516 following special commands:
15517
15518 @table @code
15519 @item set debug hppa
15520 @kindex set debug hppa
15521 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15522 messages are to be displayed.
15523
15524 @item show debug hppa
15525 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15526
15527 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15528 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15529 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15530 given @var{address}.
15531
15532 @end table
15533
15534
15535 @node Controlling GDB
15536 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15537
15538 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15539 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15540 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15541 described here.
15542
15543 @menu
15544 * Prompt:: Prompt
15545 * Editing:: Command editing
15546 * Command History:: Command history
15547 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15548 * Numbers:: Numbers
15549 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15550 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15551 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15552 @end menu
15553
15554 @node Prompt
15555 @section Prompt
15556
15557 @cindex prompt
15558
15559 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15560 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15561 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15562 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15563 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15564 which one you are talking to.
15565
15566 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15567 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15568 or a prompt that does not.
15569
15570 @table @code
15571 @kindex set prompt
15572 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15573 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15574
15575 @kindex show prompt
15576 @item show prompt
15577 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15578 @end table
15579
15580 @node Editing
15581 @section Command editing
15582 @cindex readline
15583 @cindex command line editing
15584
15585 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15586 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15587 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15588 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15589 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15590 debugging sessions.
15591
15592 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15593 command @code{set}.
15594
15595 @table @code
15596 @kindex set editing
15597 @cindex editing
15598 @item set editing
15599 @itemx set editing on
15600 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15601
15602 @item set editing off
15603 Disable command line editing.
15604
15605 @kindex show editing
15606 @item show editing
15607 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15608 @end table
15609
15610 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15611 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15612 encouraged to read that chapter.
15613
15614 @node Command History
15615 @section Command history
15616 @cindex command history
15617
15618 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15619 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15620 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15621 history facility.
15622
15623 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15624 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15625 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15626
15627 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15628 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15629 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15630 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15631 pressed on a line by itself.
15632
15633 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15634 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15635 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15636 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15637
15638 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15639 history.
15640
15641 @table @code
15642 @cindex history substitution
15643 @cindex history file
15644 @kindex set history filename
15645 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15646 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15647 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15648 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15649 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15650 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15651 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15652 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15653 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15654 is not set.
15655
15656 @cindex save command history
15657 @kindex set history save
15658 @item set history save
15659 @itemx set history save on
15660 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15661 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15662
15663 @item set history save off
15664 Stop recording command history in a file.
15665
15666 @cindex history size
15667 @kindex set history size
15668 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15669 @item set history size @var{size}
15670 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15671 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15672 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15673 @end table
15674
15675 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15676 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15677
15678 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15679 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15680 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15681 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15682 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15683 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15684 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15685 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15686
15687 The commands to control history expansion are:
15688
15689 @table @code
15690 @item set history expansion on
15691 @itemx set history expansion
15692 @kindex set history expansion
15693 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15694
15695 @item set history expansion off
15696 Disable history expansion.
15697
15698 @c @group
15699 @kindex show history
15700 @item show history
15701 @itemx show history filename
15702 @itemx show history save
15703 @itemx show history size
15704 @itemx show history expansion
15705 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15706 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15707 @c @end group
15708 @end table
15709
15710 @table @code
15711 @kindex show commands
15712 @cindex show last commands
15713 @cindex display command history
15714 @item show commands
15715 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15716
15717 @item show commands @var{n}
15718 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15719
15720 @item show commands +
15721 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15722 @end table
15723
15724 @node Screen Size
15725 @section Screen size
15726 @cindex size of screen
15727 @cindex pauses in output
15728
15729 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15730 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15731 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15732 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15733 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15734 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15735 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15736 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15737
15738 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15739 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15740 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15741 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15742 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15743 width} commands:
15744
15745 @table @code
15746 @kindex set height
15747 @kindex set width
15748 @kindex show width
15749 @kindex show height
15750 @item set height @var{lpp}
15751 @itemx show height
15752 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15753 @itemx show width
15754 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15755 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15756 commands display the current settings.
15757
15758 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15759 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15760 file or to an editor buffer.
15761
15762 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15763 from wrapping its output.
15764
15765 @item set pagination on
15766 @itemx set pagination off
15767 @kindex set pagination
15768 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15769 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15770
15771 @item show pagination
15772 @kindex show pagination
15773 Show the current pagination mode.
15774 @end table
15775
15776 @node Numbers
15777 @section Numbers
15778 @cindex number representation
15779 @cindex entering numbers
15780
15781 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15782 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15783 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15784 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15785 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15786 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15787 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15788 both input and output with the commands described below.
15789
15790 @table @code
15791 @kindex set input-radix
15792 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15793 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15794 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15795 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15796 example, any of
15797
15798 @smallexample
15799 set input-radix 012
15800 set input-radix 10.
15801 set input-radix 0xa
15802 @end smallexample
15803
15804 @noindent
15805 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15806 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15807 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15808 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15809 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15810 change the radix.
15811
15812 @kindex set output-radix
15813 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15814 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15815 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15816 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15817
15818 @kindex show input-radix
15819 @item show input-radix
15820 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15821
15822 @kindex show output-radix
15823 @item show output-radix
15824 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15825
15826 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15827 @itemx show radix
15828 @kindex set radix
15829 @kindex show radix
15830 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15831 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15832 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15833 default value of 10.
15834
15835 @end table
15836
15837 @node ABI
15838 @section Configuring the current ABI
15839
15840 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15841 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15842 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15843 current ABI.
15844
15845 @cindex OS ABI
15846 @kindex set osabi
15847 @kindex show osabi
15848
15849 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15850 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15851 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15852 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15853 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15854 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15855 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15856 platform provides.
15857
15858 @table @code
15859 @item show osabi
15860 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15861
15862 @item set osabi
15863 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15864
15865 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15866 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15867 @end table
15868
15869 @cindex float promotion
15870
15871 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15872 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15873 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15874 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15875 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15876 @code{double} and then passed.
15877
15878 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15879 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15880 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15881
15882 @table @code
15883 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15884 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15885 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15886 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15887 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15888
15889 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15890 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15891 functions.
15892
15893 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15894 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15895 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15896 @end table
15897
15898 @kindex set cp-abi
15899 @kindex show cp-abi
15900 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15901 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15902 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15903 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15904 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15905 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15906 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15907 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15908 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15909 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15910 ``auto''.
15911
15912 @table @code
15913 @item show cp-abi
15914 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15915
15916 @item set cp-abi
15917 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15918
15919 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15920 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15921 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15922 @end table
15923
15924 @node Messages/Warnings
15925 @section Optional warnings and messages
15926
15927 @cindex verbose operation
15928 @cindex optional warnings
15929 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15930 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15931 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15932 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15933
15934 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15935 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15936 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
15937
15938 @table @code
15939 @kindex set verbose
15940 @item set verbose on
15941 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15942
15943 @item set verbose off
15944 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15945
15946 @kindex show verbose
15947 @item show verbose
15948 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15949 @end table
15950
15951 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15952 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15953 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
15954 symbol files}).
15955
15956 @table @code
15957
15958 @kindex set complaints
15959 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15960 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15961 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15962 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15963 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15964
15965 @kindex show complaints
15966 @item show complaints
15967 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15968
15969 @end table
15970
15971 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15972 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15973 you try to run a program which is already running:
15974
15975 @smallexample
15976 (@value{GDBP}) run
15977 The program being debugged has been started already.
15978 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15979 @end smallexample
15980
15981 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15982 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15983
15984 @table @code
15985
15986 @kindex set confirm
15987 @cindex flinching
15988 @cindex confirmation
15989 @cindex stupid questions
15990 @item set confirm off
15991 Disables confirmation requests.
15992
15993 @item set confirm on
15994 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15995
15996 @kindex show confirm
15997 @item show confirm
15998 Displays state of confirmation requests.
15999
16000 @end table
16001
16002 @node Debugging Output
16003 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
16004 @cindex optional debugging messages
16005
16006 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16007 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16008 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16009 section documents those commands.
16010
16011 @table @code
16012 @kindex set exec-done-display
16013 @item set exec-done-display
16014 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16015 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16016 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16017 @kindex show exec-done-display
16018 @item show exec-done-display
16019 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16020 notification.
16021 @kindex set debug
16022 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16023 @cindex architecture debugging info
16024 @item set debug arch
16025 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16026 @kindex show debug
16027 @item show debug arch
16028 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16029 @item set debug aix-thread
16030 @cindex AIX threads
16031 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16032 module.
16033 @item show debug aix-thread
16034 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16035 @item set debug event
16036 @cindex event debugging info
16037 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16038 default is off.
16039 @item show debug event
16040 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16041 info.
16042 @item set debug expression
16043 @cindex expression debugging info
16044 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16045 expression parsing. The default is off.
16046 @item show debug expression
16047 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16048 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16049 @item set debug frame
16050 @cindex frame debugging info
16051 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16052 default is off.
16053 @item show debug frame
16054 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16055 info.
16056 @item set debug infrun
16057 @cindex inferior debugging info
16058 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16059 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16060 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16061 @item show debug infrun
16062 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16063 @item set debug lin-lwp
16064 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16065 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16066 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16067 @item show debug lin-lwp
16068 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16069 @item set debug observer
16070 @cindex observer debugging info
16071 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16072 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16073 @item show debug observer
16074 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16075 @item set debug overload
16076 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16077 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16078 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16079 is off.
16080 @item show debug overload
16081 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16082 debugging info.
16083 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16084 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16085 @cindex debug remote protocol
16086 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16087 @cindex display remote packets
16088 @item set debug remote
16089 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16090 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16091 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16092 @item show debug remote
16093 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16094 @item set debug serial
16095 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16096 default is off.
16097 @item show debug serial
16098 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16099 info.
16100 @item set debug solib-frv
16101 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16102 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16103 @item show debug solib-frv
16104 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16105 messages.
16106 @item set debug target
16107 @cindex target debugging info
16108 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16109 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16110 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16111 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16112 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16113 @item show debug target
16114 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16115 info.
16116 @item set debugvarobj
16117 @cindex variable object debugging info
16118 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16119 info. The default is off.
16120 @item show debugvarobj
16121 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16122 debugging info.
16123 @end table
16124
16125 @node Sequences
16126 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16127
16128 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16129 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16130 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16131 files.
16132
16133 @menu
16134 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16135 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16136 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16137 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16138 @end menu
16139
16140 @node Define
16141 @section User-defined commands
16142
16143 @cindex user-defined command
16144 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16145 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16146 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16147 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16148 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16149 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16150
16151 @smallexample
16152 define adder
16153 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16154 end
16155 @end smallexample
16156
16157 @noindent
16158 To execute the command use:
16159
16160 @smallexample
16161 adder 1 2 3
16162 @end smallexample
16163
16164 @noindent
16165 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16166 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16167 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16168 functions calls.
16169
16170 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16171 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16172 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16173 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16174
16175 @smallexample
16176 define adder
16177 if $argc == 2
16178 print $arg0 + $arg1
16179 end
16180 if $argc == 3
16181 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16182 end
16183 end
16184 @end smallexample
16185
16186 @table @code
16187
16188 @kindex define
16189 @item define @var{commandname}
16190 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16191 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16192
16193 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16194 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16195 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16196
16197 @kindex document
16198 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16199 @item document @var{commandname}
16200 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16201 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16202 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16203 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16204 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16205 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16206
16207 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16208 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16209 does not change the documentation.
16210
16211 @kindex dont-repeat
16212 @cindex don't repeat command
16213 @item dont-repeat
16214 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16215 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16216 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16217
16218 @kindex help user-defined
16219 @item help user-defined
16220 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16221 (if any) for each.
16222
16223 @kindex show user
16224 @item show user
16225 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16226 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16227 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16228 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16229
16230 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16231 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16232 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16233 @item show max-user-call-depth
16234 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16235 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16236 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16237 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16238 @end table
16239
16240 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16241 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16242
16243 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16244 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16245 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16246
16247 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16248 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16249 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16250 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16251
16252 @node Hooks
16253 @section User-defined command hooks
16254 @cindex command hooks
16255 @cindex hooks, for commands
16256 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16257
16258 @kindex hook
16259 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16260 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16261 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16262 before that command.
16263
16264 @cindex hooks, post-command
16265 @kindex hookpost
16266 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16267 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16268 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16269 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16270 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16271
16272 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16273 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16274
16275 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16276 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16277
16278 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16279 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16280 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16281 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16282 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16283
16284 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16285 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16286 you could define:
16287
16288 @smallexample
16289 define hook-stop
16290 handle SIGALRM nopass
16291 end
16292
16293 define hook-run
16294 handle SIGALRM pass
16295 end
16296
16297 define hook-continue
16298 handle SIGLARM pass
16299 end
16300 @end smallexample
16301
16302 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
16303 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16304 you could define:
16305
16306 @smallexample
16307 define hook-echo
16308 echo <<<---
16309 end
16310
16311 define hookpost-echo
16312 echo --->>>\n
16313 end
16314
16315 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16316 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16317 (@value{GDBP})
16318
16319 @end smallexample
16320
16321 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16322 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16323 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16324 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16325 @c or not?
16326 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16327 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16328 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16329
16330 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16331 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16332
16333 @node Command Files
16334 @section Command files
16335
16336 @cindex command files
16337 @cindex scripting commands
16338 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16339 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16340 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16341 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16342 terminal.
16343
16344 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16345 command:
16346
16347 @table @code
16348 @kindex source
16349 @cindex execute commands from a file
16350 @item source @var{filename}
16351 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16352 @end table
16353
16354 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16355 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16356 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16357 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16358 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16359
16360 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16361 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16362
16363 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16364 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16365 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16366 when called from command files.
16367
16368 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16369 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16370 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16371 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16372 the next command.
16373
16374 @smallexample
16375 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16376 @end smallexample
16377
16378 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16379 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16380 would be directed to @file{log}.
16381
16382 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16383 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16384 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16385 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16386 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16387 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16388 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16389 conditionally, etc.
16390
16391 @table @code
16392 @kindex if
16393 @kindex else
16394 @item if
16395 @itemx else
16396 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16397 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16398 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16399 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16400 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16401 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16402 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16403
16404 @kindex while
16405 @item while
16406 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16407 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16408 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16409 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16410 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16411 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16412
16413 @kindex loop_break
16414 @item loop_break
16415 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16416 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16417 line.
16418
16419 @kindex loop_continue
16420 @item loop_continue
16421 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16422 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16423 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16424 the controlling expression.
16425
16426 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16427 @item end
16428 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16429 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16430 @end table
16431
16432
16433 @node Output
16434 @section Commands for controlled output
16435
16436 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16437 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16438 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16439 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16440 want.
16441
16442 @table @code
16443 @kindex echo
16444 @item echo @var{text}
16445 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16446 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16447 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16448 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16449 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16450 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16451 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16452 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16453 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16454 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16455 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16456
16457 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16458 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16459
16460 @smallexample
16461 echo This is some text\n\
16462 which is continued\n\
16463 onto several lines.\n
16464 @end smallexample
16465
16466 produces the same output as
16467
16468 @smallexample
16469 echo This is some text\n
16470 echo which is continued\n
16471 echo onto several lines.\n
16472 @end smallexample
16473
16474 @kindex output
16475 @item output @var{expression}
16476 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16477 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16478 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16479 on expressions.
16480
16481 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16482 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16483 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16484 formats}, for more information.
16485
16486 @kindex printf
16487 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16488 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16489 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16490 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16491 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16492 subroutine
16493 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16494 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16495 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16496 @c supported.
16497
16498 @smallexample
16499 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16500 @end smallexample
16501
16502 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16503
16504 @smallexample
16505 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16506 @end smallexample
16507
16508 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16509 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16510 letter.
16511 @end table
16512
16513 @node Interpreters
16514 @chapter Command Interpreters
16515 @cindex command interpreters
16516
16517 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16518 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16519 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16520
16521 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16522 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16523 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16524 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16525
16526 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16527 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16528 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16529 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16530
16531 @table @code
16532 @item console
16533 @cindex console interpreter
16534 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16535 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16536 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16537
16538 @item mi
16539 @cindex mi interpreter
16540 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16541 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16542 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16543 Interface}.
16544
16545 @item mi2
16546 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16547 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16548
16549 @item mi1
16550 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16551 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16552
16553 @end table
16554
16555 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16556 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16557 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16558 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16559 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16560 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16561 the IDE inoperable!
16562
16563 @kindex interpreter-exec
16564 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16565 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16566 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16567 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16568
16569 @smallexample
16570 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16571 @end smallexample
16572
16573 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16574 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16575
16576 @node TUI
16577 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16578 @cindex TUI
16579 @cindex Text User Interface
16580
16581 @menu
16582 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16583 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16584 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16585 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16586 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16587 @end menu
16588
16589 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16590 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16591 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16592 commands in separate text windows.
16593
16594 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16595 @pindex gdbtui
16596 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16597
16598 @node TUI Overview
16599 @section TUI overview
16600
16601 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16602 @value{GDBN} runs:
16603
16604 @itemize @bullet
16605 @item
16606 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16607 windows on the terminal.
16608
16609 @item
16610 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16611 the TUI.
16612 @end itemize
16613
16614 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16615 on the terminal:
16616
16617 @table @emph
16618 @item command
16619 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16620 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16621 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16622 window is always visible.
16623
16624 @item source
16625 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16626 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16627
16628 @item assembly
16629 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16630
16631 @item register
16632 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16633 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16634 changed are highlighted.
16635
16636 @end table
16637
16638 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16639 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16640 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16641 indicates the breakpoint type:
16642
16643 @table @code
16644 @item B
16645 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16646
16647 @item b
16648 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16649
16650 @item H
16651 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16652
16653 @item h
16654 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16655
16656 @end table
16657
16658 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16659
16660 @table @code
16661 @item +
16662 Breakpoint is enabled.
16663
16664 @item -
16665 Breakpoint is disabled.
16666
16667 @end table
16668
16669 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16670 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16671 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16672 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16673 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16674 The following layouts are available:
16675
16676 @itemize @bullet
16677 @item
16678 source
16679
16680 @item
16681 assembly
16682
16683 @item
16684 source and assembly
16685
16686 @item
16687 source and registers
16688
16689 @item
16690 assembly and registers
16691
16692 @end itemize
16693
16694 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16695 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16696 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16697 are displayed:
16698
16699 @table @emph
16700 @item target
16701 Indicates the current gdb target
16702 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16703
16704 @item process
16705 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16706 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16707
16708 @item function
16709 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16710 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16711 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16712 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16713
16714 @item line
16715 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16716 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16717
16718 @item pc
16719 Indicates the current program counter address.
16720
16721 @end table
16722
16723 @node TUI Keys
16724 @section TUI Key Bindings
16725 @cindex TUI key bindings
16726
16727 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16728 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16729 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16730 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16731 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16732 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16733 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16734
16735 @table @kbd
16736 @kindex C-x C-a
16737 @item C-x C-a
16738 @kindex C-x a
16739 @itemx C-x a
16740 @kindex C-x A
16741 @itemx C-x A
16742 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16743 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16744 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16745 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16746 The screen is then refreshed.
16747
16748 @kindex C-x 1
16749 @item C-x 1
16750 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16751 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16752 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16753
16754 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16755
16756 @kindex C-x 2
16757 @item C-x 2
16758 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16759 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16760 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16761 previous layout and the new one.
16762
16763 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16764
16765 @kindex C-x o
16766 @item C-x o
16767 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16768 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16769 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16770
16771 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16772
16773 @kindex C-x s
16774 @item C-x s
16775 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16776 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16777
16778 @end table
16779
16780 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16781
16782 @table @key
16783 @kindex PgUp
16784 @item PgUp
16785 Scroll the active window one page up.
16786
16787 @kindex PgDn
16788 @item PgDn
16789 Scroll the active window one page down.
16790
16791 @kindex Up
16792 @item Up
16793 Scroll the active window one line up.
16794
16795 @kindex Down
16796 @item Down
16797 Scroll the active window one line down.
16798
16799 @kindex Left
16800 @item Left
16801 Scroll the active window one column left.
16802
16803 @kindex Right
16804 @item Right
16805 Scroll the active window one column right.
16806
16807 @kindex C-L
16808 @item C-L
16809 Refresh the screen.
16810
16811 @end table
16812
16813 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16814 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16815 active window is the command window. When the command window
16816 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16817 key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
16818
16819 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16820 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16821 @cindex TUI single key mode
16822
16823 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16824 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16825 some gdb commands.
16826
16827 @table @kbd
16828 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16829 @item c
16830 continue
16831
16832 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16833 @item d
16834 down
16835
16836 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16837 @item f
16838 finish
16839
16840 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16841 @item n
16842 next
16843
16844 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16845 @item q
16846 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16847
16848 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16849 @item r
16850 run
16851
16852 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16853 @item s
16854 step
16855
16856 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16857 @item u
16858 up
16859
16860 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16861 @item v
16862 info locals
16863
16864 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16865 @item w
16866 where
16867
16868 @end table
16869
16870 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16871 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16872 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16873 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16874 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16875 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
16876
16877
16878 @node TUI Commands
16879 @section TUI specific commands
16880 @cindex TUI commands
16881
16882 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16883 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
16884 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
16885 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
16886 in the TUI mode.
16887
16888 @table @code
16889 @item info win
16890 @kindex info win
16891 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16892
16893 @item layout next
16894 @kindex layout
16895 Display the next layout.
16896
16897 @item layout prev
16898 Display the previous layout.
16899
16900 @item layout src
16901 Display the source window only.
16902
16903 @item layout asm
16904 Display the assembly window only.
16905
16906 @item layout split
16907 Display the source and assembly window.
16908
16909 @item layout regs
16910 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16911
16912 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
16913 @kindex focus
16914 Set the focus to the named window.
16915 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
16916 can be affected to another window.
16917
16918 @item refresh
16919 @kindex refresh
16920 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
16921
16922 @item tui reg float
16923 @kindex tui reg
16924 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16925
16926 @item tui reg general
16927 Show the general registers in the register window.
16928
16929 @item tui reg next
16930 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16931 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16932 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16933 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16934
16935 @item tui reg system
16936 Show the system registers in the register window.
16937
16938 @item update
16939 @kindex update
16940 Update the source window and the current execution point.
16941
16942 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16943 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16944 @kindex winheight
16945 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16946 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16947 decrease it.
16948
16949 @item tabset
16950 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
16951 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16952
16953 @end table
16954
16955 @node TUI Configuration
16956 @section TUI configuration variables
16957 @cindex TUI configuration variables
16958
16959 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
16960 appearance of windows on the terminal.
16961
16962 @table @code
16963 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16964 @kindex set tui border-kind
16965 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16966 The possible values are the following:
16967 @table @code
16968 @item space
16969 Use a space character to draw the border.
16970
16971 @item ascii
16972 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
16973
16974 @item acs
16975 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16976 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16977
16978 @end table
16979
16980 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16981 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
16982 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
16983 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
16984 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
16985
16986 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16987 @kindex set tui border-mode
16988 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
16989 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16990 @table @code
16991 @item normal
16992 Use normal attributes to display the border.
16993
16994 @item standout
16995 Use standout mode.
16996
16997 @item reverse
16998 Use reverse video mode.
16999
17000 @item half
17001 Use half bright mode.
17002
17003 @item half-standout
17004 Use half bright and standout mode.
17005
17006 @item bold
17007 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17008
17009 @item bold-standout
17010 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17011
17012 @end table
17013
17014 @end table
17015
17016 @node Emacs
17017 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17018
17019 @cindex Emacs
17020 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17021 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17022 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17023 @value{GDBN}.
17024
17025 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17026 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17027 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17028 created Emacs buffer.
17029 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17030
17031 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17032 things:
17033
17034 @itemize @bullet
17035 @item
17036 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
17037 @end itemize
17038
17039 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17040 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17041
17042 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17043 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17044 in this way.
17045
17046 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17047 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17048 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17049 stop.
17050
17051 @itemize @bullet
17052 @item
17053 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17054 @end itemize
17055
17056 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17057 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17058 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17059 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17060 and the source.
17061
17062 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17063 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17064
17065 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17066 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17067 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17068 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17069 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17070 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17071 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17072 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17073 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17074
17075 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17076 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
17077 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
17078 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
17079
17080 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17081 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17082 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17083 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17084 one you want.
17085
17086 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17087 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17088
17089 @table @kbd
17090 @item C-h m
17091 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
17092
17093 @item C-c C-s
17094 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17095 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17096
17097 @item C-c C-n
17098 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17099 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17100 to show the current file and location.
17101
17102 @item C-c C-i
17103 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17104 display window accordingly.
17105
17106 @item C-c C-f
17107 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17108 @code{finish} command.
17109
17110 @item C-c C-r
17111 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17112 command.
17113
17114 @item C-c <
17115 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17116 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17117 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17118
17119 @item C-c >
17120 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17121 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17122 @end table
17123
17124 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gud-break})
17125 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17126
17127 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
17128 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
17129 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
17130 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
17131 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
17132 current one.
17133
17134 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17135 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17136 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17137 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17138 frame.
17139
17140 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17141 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17142 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17143 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17144 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17145 to correspond properly with the code.
17146
17147 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
17148 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
17149 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17150
17151 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17152 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17153 @ignore
17154 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17155 @kindex Epoch
17156 @kindex inspect
17157
17158 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17159 called the @code{epoch}
17160 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17161 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17162 each value is printed in its own window.
17163 @end ignore
17164
17165
17166 @node GDB/MI
17167 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17168
17169 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17170
17171 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17172 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17173 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17174 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17175 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17176 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17177
17178 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17179 in the form of a reference manual.
17180
17181 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17182 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17183 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17184
17185 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17186
17187 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17188 This chapter uses the following notation:
17189
17190 @itemize @bullet
17191 @item
17192 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17193
17194 @item
17195 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17196 it may or may not be given.
17197
17198 @item
17199 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17200 may repeat zero or more times.
17201
17202 @item
17203 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17204 may repeat one or more times.
17205
17206 @item
17207 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17208 @end itemize
17209
17210 @ignore
17211 @heading Dependencies
17212 @end ignore
17213
17214 @menu
17215 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17216 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17217 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17218 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17219 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17220 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17221 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17222 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17223 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17224 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17225 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17226 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17227 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17228 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17229 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17230 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17231 @ignore
17232 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17233 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17234 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17235 @end ignore
17236 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17237 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17238 @end menu
17239
17240 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17241 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17242 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17243
17244 @menu
17245 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17246 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17247 @end menu
17248
17249 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17250 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17251
17252 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17253 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17254 @table @code
17255 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17256 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17257
17258 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17259 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17260 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17261
17262 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17263 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17264 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17265
17266 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17267 "any sequence of digits"
17268
17269 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17270 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17271
17272 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17273 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17274
17275 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17276 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17277
17278 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17279 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17280 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17281
17282 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17283 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17284
17285 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17286 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17287 @end table
17288
17289 @noindent
17290 Notes:
17291
17292 @itemize @bullet
17293 @item
17294 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17295 output is described below.
17296
17297 @item
17298 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17299 finishes.
17300
17301 @item
17302 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17303 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17304 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17305 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17306 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17307 @end itemize
17308
17309 Pragmatics:
17310
17311 @itemize @bullet
17312 @item
17313 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17314
17315 @item
17316 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17317 @end itemize
17318
17319 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17320 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17321
17322 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17323 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17324 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17325 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17326 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17327 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17328
17329 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17330 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17331 @var{token}.
17332
17333 @table @code
17334 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17335 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17336
17337 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17338 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17339
17340 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17341 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17342
17343 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17344 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17345
17346 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17347 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17348
17349 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17350 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17351
17352 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17353 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17354
17355 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17356 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17357
17358 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17359 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17360
17361 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17362 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17363 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17364
17365 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17366 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17367
17368 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17369 @code{ @var{string} }
17370
17371 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17372 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17373
17374 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17375 @code{@var{c-string}}
17376
17377 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17378 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17379
17380 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17381 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17382 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17383
17384 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17385 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17386
17387 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17388 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17389
17390 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17391 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17392
17393 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17394 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17395
17396 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17397 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17398
17399 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17400 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17401 @end table
17402
17403 @noindent
17404 Notes:
17405
17406 @itemize @bullet
17407 @item
17408 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17409
17410 @item
17411 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17412 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17413 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17414 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17415
17416 @item
17417 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17418 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17419 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17420 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17421
17422 @item
17423 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17424 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17425 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17426 @samp{*}.
17427
17428 @item
17429 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17430 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17431 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17432 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17433
17434 @item
17435 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17436 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17437 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17438 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17439
17440 @item
17441 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17442 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17443 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17444
17445 @item
17446 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17447 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17448 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17449 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17450
17451 @item
17452 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17453 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17454 @var{values}.
17455
17456
17457 @end itemize
17458
17459 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17460 details about the various output records.
17461
17462 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17463 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17464 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17465
17466 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17467 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17468
17469 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17470 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17471 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17472 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17473 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17474 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17475
17476 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17477 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17478 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17479
17480 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17481 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17482 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17483 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17484
17485 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17486 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17487
17488 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17489 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17490 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17491 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17492 might change.
17493
17494 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17495 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17496 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17497 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17498
17499 @itemize @bullet
17500 @item
17501 New MI commands may be added.
17502
17503 @item
17504 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17505
17506 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17507 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17508
17509 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17510 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17511 @end itemize
17512
17513 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17514 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17515 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17516 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17517 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17518
17519 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17520 @c version?
17521
17522 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17523 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17524 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17525 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17526 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17527 Group, which has the aim of creating a a more general MI protocol
17528 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17529 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17530 @cindex mailing lists
17531
17532 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17533 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17534 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17535
17536 @menu
17537 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17538 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17539 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17540 @end menu
17541
17542 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17543 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17544
17545 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17546 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17547 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17548 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17549
17550 @table @code
17551 @findex ^done
17552 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17553 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17554 values.
17555
17556 @item "^running"
17557 @findex ^running
17558 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17559 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17560 running.
17561
17562 @item "^connected"
17563 @findex ^connected
17564 GDB has connected to a remote target.
17565
17566 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17567 @findex ^error
17568 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17569 error message.
17570
17571 @item "^exit"
17572 @findex ^exit
17573 GDB has terminated.
17574
17575 @end table
17576
17577 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17578 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17579
17580 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17581 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17582 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17583 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17584 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17585
17586 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17587 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17588 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17589 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17590 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17591
17592 @table @code
17593 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17594 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17595 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17596
17597 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17598 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17599 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17600 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17601
17602 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17603 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17604 internals.
17605 @end table
17606
17607 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17608 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17609
17610 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17611 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17612 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17613 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17614 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17615 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17616
17617 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17618 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17619
17620 @table @code
17621 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17622 @end table
17623
17624 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17625
17626 @table @code
17627 @item breakpoint-hit
17628 A breakpoint was reached.
17629 @item watchpoint-trigger
17630 A watchpoint was triggered.
17631 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17632 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17633 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17634 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17635 @item function-finished
17636 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17637 @item location-reached
17638 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17639 @item watchpoint-scope
17640 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17641 @item end-stepping-range
17642 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17643 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17644 @item exited-signalled
17645 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17646 @item exited
17647 The inferior exited.
17648 @item exited-normally
17649 The inferior exited normally.
17650 @item signal-received
17651 A signal was received by the inferior.
17652 @end table
17653
17654
17655 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17656 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17657 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17658 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17659
17660 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17661 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17662 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17663 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17664
17665 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17666 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17667
17668 @subheading Setting a breakpoint
17669
17670 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17671 information of the breakpoint.
17672
17673 @smallexample
17674 -> -break-insert main
17675 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17676 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17677 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17678 <- (gdb)
17679 @end smallexample
17680
17681 @subheading Program Execution
17682
17683 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17684 reason that execution stopped.
17685
17686 @smallexample
17687 -> -exec-run
17688 <- ^running
17689 <- (gdb)
17690 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17691 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17692 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17693 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17694 <- (gdb)
17695 -> -exec-continue
17696 <- ^running
17697 <- (gdb)
17698 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17699 <- (gdb)
17700 @end smallexample
17701
17702 @subheading Quitting GDB
17703
17704 Quitting GDB just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17705
17706 @smallexample
17707 -> (gdb)
17708 <- -gdb-exit
17709 <- ^exit
17710 @end smallexample
17711
17712 @subheading A Bad Command
17713
17714 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17715
17716 @smallexample
17717 -> -rubbish
17718 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17719 <- (gdb)
17720 @end smallexample
17721
17722
17723 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17724 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17725 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17726
17727 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17728 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17729
17730 @subheading Motivation
17731
17732 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17733
17734 @subheading Introduction
17735
17736 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17737
17738 @subheading Commands
17739
17740 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17741
17742 @subsubheading Synopsis
17743
17744 @smallexample
17745 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17746 @end smallexample
17747
17748 @subsubheading Result
17749
17750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17751
17752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17753
17754 @subsubheading Example
17755
17756 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17757 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17758
17759
17760 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17761 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17762 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17763
17764 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17765 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17766 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17767 breakpoints.
17768
17769 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17770 @findex -break-after
17771
17772 @subsubheading Synopsis
17773
17774 @smallexample
17775 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17776 @end smallexample
17777
17778 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17779 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17780 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17781 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17782
17783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17784
17785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17786
17787 @subsubheading Example
17788
17789 @smallexample
17790 (gdb)
17791 -break-insert main
17792 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17793 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17794 (gdb)
17795 -break-after 1 3
17796 ~
17797 ^done
17798 (gdb)
17799 -break-list
17800 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17801 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17802 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17803 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17804 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17805 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17806 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17807 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17808 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17809 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17810 (gdb)
17811 @end smallexample
17812
17813 @ignore
17814 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17815 @findex -break-catch
17816
17817 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17818 @findex -break-commands
17819 @end ignore
17820
17821
17822 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17823 @findex -break-condition
17824
17825 @subsubheading Synopsis
17826
17827 @smallexample
17828 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17829 @end smallexample
17830
17831 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17832 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17833 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17834 command below).
17835
17836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17837
17838 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17839
17840 @subsubheading Example
17841
17842 @smallexample
17843 (gdb)
17844 -break-condition 1 1
17845 ^done
17846 (gdb)
17847 -break-list
17848 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17849 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17850 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17851 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17852 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17853 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17854 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17855 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17856 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17857 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17858 (gdb)
17859 @end smallexample
17860
17861 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17862 @findex -break-delete
17863
17864 @subsubheading Synopsis
17865
17866 @smallexample
17867 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17868 @end smallexample
17869
17870 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17871 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17872
17873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17874
17875 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17876
17877 @subsubheading Example
17878
17879 @smallexample
17880 (gdb)
17881 -break-delete 1
17882 ^done
17883 (gdb)
17884 -break-list
17885 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17886 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17887 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17888 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17889 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17890 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17891 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17892 body=[]@}
17893 (gdb)
17894 @end smallexample
17895
17896 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17897 @findex -break-disable
17898
17899 @subsubheading Synopsis
17900
17901 @smallexample
17902 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17903 @end smallexample
17904
17905 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17906 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17907
17908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17909
17910 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17911
17912 @subsubheading Example
17913
17914 @smallexample
17915 (gdb)
17916 -break-disable 2
17917 ^done
17918 (gdb)
17919 -break-list
17920 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17921 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17922 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17923 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17924 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17925 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17926 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17927 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17928 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17929 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17930 (gdb)
17931 @end smallexample
17932
17933 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17934 @findex -break-enable
17935
17936 @subsubheading Synopsis
17937
17938 @smallexample
17939 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17940 @end smallexample
17941
17942 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17943
17944 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17945
17946 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17947
17948 @subsubheading Example
17949
17950 @smallexample
17951 (gdb)
17952 -break-enable 2
17953 ^done
17954 (gdb)
17955 -break-list
17956 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17957 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17958 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17959 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17960 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17961 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17962 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17963 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17964 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17965 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17966 (gdb)
17967 @end smallexample
17968
17969 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17970 @findex -break-info
17971
17972 @subsubheading Synopsis
17973
17974 @smallexample
17975 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17976 @end smallexample
17977
17978 @c REDUNDANT???
17979 Get information about a single breakpoint.
17980
17981 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17982
17983 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17984
17985 @subsubheading Example
17986 N.A.
17987
17988 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
17989 @findex -break-insert
17990
17991 @subsubheading Synopsis
17992
17993 @smallexample
17994 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
17995 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
17996 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
17997 @end smallexample
17998
17999 @noindent
18000 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18001
18002 @itemize @bullet
18003 @item function
18004 @c @item +offset
18005 @c @item -offset
18006 @c @item linenum
18007 @item filename:linenum
18008 @item filename:function
18009 @item *address
18010 @end itemize
18011
18012 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18013
18014 @table @samp
18015 @item -t
18016 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18017 @item -h
18018 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18019 @item -c @var{condition}
18020 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18021 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18022 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18023 @item -r
18024 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18025 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18026 expresson.
18027 @end table
18028
18029 @subsubheading Result
18030
18031 The result is in the form:
18032
18033 @smallexample
18034 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18035 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18036 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18037 times="@var{times}"@}
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040 @noindent
18041 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18042 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18043 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18044 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18045 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18046 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18047 which use the same output).
18048
18049 Note: this format is open to change.
18050 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18051
18052 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18053
18054 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18055 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18056
18057 @subsubheading Example
18058
18059 @smallexample
18060 (gdb)
18061 -break-insert main
18062 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18063 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18064 (gdb)
18065 -break-insert -t foo
18066 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18067 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18068 (gdb)
18069 -break-list
18070 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18071 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18072 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18073 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18074 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18075 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18076 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18077 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18078 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18079 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18080 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18081 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18082 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18083 (gdb)
18084 -break-insert -r foo.*
18085 ~int foo(int, int);
18086 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18087 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18088 (gdb)
18089 @end smallexample
18090
18091 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18092 @findex -break-list
18093
18094 @subsubheading Synopsis
18095
18096 @smallexample
18097 -break-list
18098 @end smallexample
18099
18100 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18101
18102 @table @samp
18103 @item Number
18104 number of the breakpoint
18105 @item Type
18106 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18107 @item Disposition
18108 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18109 or @samp{nokeep}
18110 @item Enabled
18111 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18112 @item Address
18113 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18114 @item What
18115 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18116 name, line number
18117 @item Times
18118 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18119 @end table
18120
18121 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18122 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18123
18124 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18125
18126 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18127
18128 @subsubheading Example
18129
18130 @smallexample
18131 (gdb)
18132 -break-list
18133 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18134 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18135 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18136 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18137 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18138 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18139 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18140 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18141 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18142 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18143 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18144 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18145 (gdb)
18146 @end smallexample
18147
18148 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18149
18150 @smallexample
18151 (gdb)
18152 -break-list
18153 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18154 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18155 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18156 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18157 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18158 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18159 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18160 body=[]@}
18161 (gdb)
18162 @end smallexample
18163
18164 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18165 @findex -break-watch
18166
18167 @subsubheading Synopsis
18168
18169 @smallexample
18170 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18171 @end smallexample
18172
18173 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18174 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18175 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18176 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
18177 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18178 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18179 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18180 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
18181
18182 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18183 breakpoints inserted.
18184
18185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18186
18187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18188 @samp{rwatch}.
18189
18190 @subsubheading Example
18191
18192 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18193
18194 @smallexample
18195 (gdb)
18196 -break-watch x
18197 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18198 (gdb)
18199 -exec-continue
18200 ^running
18201 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18202 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18203 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18204 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18205 (gdb)
18206 @end smallexample
18207
18208 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18209 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18210 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18211
18212 @smallexample
18213 (gdb)
18214 -break-watch C
18215 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18216 (gdb)
18217 -exec-continue
18218 ^running
18219 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18220 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18221 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18222 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18223 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18224 (gdb)
18225 -exec-continue
18226 ^running
18227 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18228 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18229 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18230 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18231 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18232 (gdb)
18233 @end smallexample
18234
18235 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18236 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18237 deleted.
18238
18239 @smallexample
18240 (gdb)
18241 -break-watch C
18242 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18243 (gdb)
18244 -break-list
18245 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18246 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18247 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18248 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18249 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18250 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18251 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18252 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18253 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18254 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18255 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18256 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18257 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18258 (gdb)
18259 -exec-continue
18260 ^running
18261 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18262 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18263 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18264 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18265 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18266 (gdb)
18267 -break-list
18268 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18269 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18270 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18271 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18272 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18273 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18274 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18275 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18276 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18277 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18278 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18279 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18280 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18281 (gdb)
18282 -exec-continue
18283 ^running
18284 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18285 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18286 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18287 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18288 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18289 (gdb)
18290 -break-list
18291 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18292 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18293 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18294 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18295 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18296 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18297 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18298 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18299 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18300 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18301 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18302 times="1"@}]@}
18303 (gdb)
18304 @end smallexample
18305
18306 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18307 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18308 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18309
18310 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18311 @findex -exec-arguments
18312
18313
18314 @subsubheading Synopsis
18315
18316 @smallexample
18317 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18318 @end smallexample
18319
18320 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18321 @samp{-exec-run}.
18322
18323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18324
18325 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18326
18327 @subsubheading Example
18328
18329 @c FIXME!
18330 Don't have one around.
18331
18332
18333 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18334 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18335
18336 @subsubheading Synopsis
18337
18338 @smallexample
18339 -exec-show-arguments
18340 @end smallexample
18341
18342 Print the arguments of the program.
18343
18344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18345
18346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18347
18348 @subsubheading Example
18349 N.A.
18350
18351
18352 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18353 @findex -environment-cd
18354
18355 @subsubheading Synopsis
18356
18357 @smallexample
18358 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18359 @end smallexample
18360
18361 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18362
18363 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18364
18365 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18366
18367 @subsubheading Example
18368
18369 @smallexample
18370 (gdb)
18371 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18372 ^done
18373 (gdb)
18374 @end smallexample
18375
18376
18377 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18378 @findex -environment-directory
18379
18380 @subsubheading Synopsis
18381
18382 @smallexample
18383 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18384 @end smallexample
18385
18386 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18387 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18388 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18389 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18390 occurs as normal.
18391 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18392 multiple directories in a single command
18393 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18394 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18395 If blanks are needed as
18396 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18397 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18398 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18399 character must not be used
18400 in any directory name.
18401 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18402
18403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18404
18405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18406
18407 @subsubheading Example
18408
18409 @smallexample
18410 (gdb)
18411 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18412 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18413 (gdb)
18414 -environment-directory ""
18415 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18416 (gdb)
18417 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18418 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18419 (gdb)
18420 -environment-directory -r
18421 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18422 (gdb)
18423 @end smallexample
18424
18425
18426 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18427 @findex -environment-path
18428
18429 @subsubheading Synopsis
18430
18431 @smallexample
18432 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18433 @end smallexample
18434
18435 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18436 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18437 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18438 supplied in addition to the
18439 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18440 occurs as normal.
18441 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18442 multiple directories in a single command
18443 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18444 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18445 If blanks are needed as
18446 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18447 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18448 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18449 character must not be used
18450 in any directory name.
18451 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18452
18453
18454 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18455
18456 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18457
18458 @subsubheading Example
18459
18460 @smallexample
18461 (gdb)
18462 -environment-path
18463 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18464 (gdb)
18465 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18466 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18467 (gdb)
18468 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18469 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18470 (gdb)
18471 @end smallexample
18472
18473
18474 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18475 @findex -environment-pwd
18476
18477 @subsubheading Synopsis
18478
18479 @smallexample
18480 -environment-pwd
18481 @end smallexample
18482
18483 Show the current working directory.
18484
18485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18486
18487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18488
18489 @subsubheading Example
18490
18491 @smallexample
18492 (gdb)
18493 -environment-pwd
18494 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18495 (gdb)
18496 @end smallexample
18497
18498 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18499 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18500 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18501
18502
18503 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18504 @findex -thread-info
18505
18506 @subsubheading Synopsis
18507
18508 @smallexample
18509 -thread-info
18510 @end smallexample
18511
18512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18513
18514 No equivalent.
18515
18516 @subsubheading Example
18517 N.A.
18518
18519
18520 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18521 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18522
18523 @subsubheading Synopsis
18524
18525 @smallexample
18526 -thread-list-all-threads
18527 @end smallexample
18528
18529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18530
18531 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18532
18533 @subsubheading Example
18534 N.A.
18535
18536
18537 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18538 @findex -thread-list-ids
18539
18540 @subsubheading Synopsis
18541
18542 @smallexample
18543 -thread-list-ids
18544 @end smallexample
18545
18546 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18547 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18548
18549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18550
18551 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18552
18553 @subsubheading Example
18554
18555 No threads present, besides the main process:
18556
18557 @smallexample
18558 (gdb)
18559 -thread-list-ids
18560 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18561 (gdb)
18562 @end smallexample
18563
18564
18565 Several threads:
18566
18567 @smallexample
18568 (gdb)
18569 -thread-list-ids
18570 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18571 number-of-threads="3"
18572 (gdb)
18573 @end smallexample
18574
18575
18576 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18577 @findex -thread-select
18578
18579 @subsubheading Synopsis
18580
18581 @smallexample
18582 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18583 @end smallexample
18584
18585 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18586 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18587
18588 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18589
18590 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18591
18592 @subsubheading Example
18593
18594 @smallexample
18595 (gdb)
18596 -exec-next
18597 ^running
18598 (gdb)
18599 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18600 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18601 (gdb)
18602 -thread-list-ids
18603 ^done,
18604 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18605 number-of-threads="3"
18606 (gdb)
18607 -thread-select 3
18608 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18609 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18610 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18611 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18612 (gdb)
18613 @end smallexample
18614
18615 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18616 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18617 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18618
18619 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18620 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently GDB only really executes
18621 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18622 other cases.
18623
18624 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18625 @findex -exec-continue
18626
18627 @subsubheading Synopsis
18628
18629 @smallexample
18630 -exec-continue
18631 @end smallexample
18632
18633 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18634 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18635
18636 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18637
18638 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18639
18640 @subsubheading Example
18641
18642 @smallexample
18643 -exec-continue
18644 ^running
18645 (gdb)
18646 @@Hello world
18647 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18648 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18649 (gdb)
18650 @end smallexample
18651
18652
18653 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18654 @findex -exec-finish
18655
18656 @subsubheading Synopsis
18657
18658 @smallexample
18659 -exec-finish
18660 @end smallexample
18661
18662 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18663 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18664
18665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18666
18667 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18668
18669 @subsubheading Example
18670
18671 Function returning @code{void}.
18672
18673 @smallexample
18674 -exec-finish
18675 ^running
18676 (gdb)
18677 @@hello from foo
18678 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18679 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18680 (gdb)
18681 @end smallexample
18682
18683 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18684 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18685 value itself.
18686
18687 @smallexample
18688 -exec-finish
18689 ^running
18690 (gdb)
18691 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18692 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18693 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18694 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18695 (gdb)
18696 @end smallexample
18697
18698
18699 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18700 @findex -exec-interrupt
18701
18702 @subsubheading Synopsis
18703
18704 @smallexample
18705 -exec-interrupt
18706 @end smallexample
18707
18708 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18709 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18710 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18711 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18712 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18713
18714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18715
18716 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18717
18718 @subsubheading Example
18719
18720 @smallexample
18721 (gdb)
18722 111-exec-continue
18723 111^running
18724
18725 (gdb)
18726 222-exec-interrupt
18727 222^done
18728 (gdb)
18729 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18730 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18731 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18732 (gdb)
18733
18734 (gdb)
18735 -exec-interrupt
18736 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18737 (gdb)
18738 @end smallexample
18739
18740
18741 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18742 @findex -exec-next
18743
18744 @subsubheading Synopsis
18745
18746 @smallexample
18747 -exec-next
18748 @end smallexample
18749
18750 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18751 of the next source line is reached.
18752
18753 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18754
18755 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18756
18757 @subsubheading Example
18758
18759 @smallexample
18760 -exec-next
18761 ^running
18762 (gdb)
18763 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18764 (gdb)
18765 @end smallexample
18766
18767
18768 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18769 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18770
18771 @subsubheading Synopsis
18772
18773 @smallexample
18774 -exec-next-instruction
18775 @end smallexample
18776
18777 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18778 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18779 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18780 printed as well.
18781
18782 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18783
18784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18785
18786 @subsubheading Example
18787
18788 @smallexample
18789 (gdb)
18790 -exec-next-instruction
18791 ^running
18792
18793 (gdb)
18794 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18795 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18796 (gdb)
18797 @end smallexample
18798
18799
18800 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18801 @findex -exec-return
18802
18803 @subsubheading Synopsis
18804
18805 @smallexample
18806 -exec-return
18807 @end smallexample
18808
18809 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18810 Displays the new current frame.
18811
18812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18813
18814 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18815
18816 @subsubheading Example
18817
18818 @smallexample
18819 (gdb)
18820 200-break-insert callee4
18821 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18822 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18823 (gdb)
18824 000-exec-run
18825 000^running
18826 (gdb)
18827 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18828 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18829 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18830 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18831 (gdb)
18832 205-break-delete
18833 205^done
18834 (gdb)
18835 111-exec-return
18836 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18837 args=[@{name="strarg",
18838 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18839 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18840 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18841 (gdb)
18842 @end smallexample
18843
18844
18845 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18846 @findex -exec-run
18847
18848 @subsubheading Synopsis
18849
18850 @smallexample
18851 -exec-run
18852 @end smallexample
18853
18854 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18855 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18856 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18857 the program has exited exceptionally.
18858
18859 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18860
18861 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18862
18863 @subsubheading Examples
18864
18865 @smallexample
18866 (gdb)
18867 -break-insert main
18868 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18869 (gdb)
18870 -exec-run
18871 ^running
18872 (gdb)
18873 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18874 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18875 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18876 (gdb)
18877 @end smallexample
18878
18879 @noindent
18880 Program exited normally:
18881
18882 @smallexample
18883 (gdb)
18884 -exec-run
18885 ^running
18886 (gdb)
18887 x = 55
18888 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18889 (gdb)
18890 @end smallexample
18891
18892 @noindent
18893 Program exited exceptionally:
18894
18895 @smallexample
18896 (gdb)
18897 -exec-run
18898 ^running
18899 (gdb)
18900 x = 55
18901 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18902 (gdb)
18903 @end smallexample
18904
18905 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18906 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18907
18908 @smallexample
18909 (gdb)
18910 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18911 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18912 @end smallexample
18913
18914
18915 @c @subheading -exec-signal
18916
18917
18918 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
18919 @findex -exec-step
18920
18921 @subsubheading Synopsis
18922
18923 @smallexample
18924 -exec-step
18925 @end smallexample
18926
18927 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18928 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
18929 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
18930 function.
18931
18932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18933
18934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
18935
18936 @subsubheading Example
18937
18938 Stepping into a function:
18939
18940 @smallexample
18941 -exec-step
18942 ^running
18943 (gdb)
18944 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18945 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
18946 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
18947 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
18948 (gdb)
18949 @end smallexample
18950
18951 Regular stepping:
18952
18953 @smallexample
18954 -exec-step
18955 ^running
18956 (gdb)
18957 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
18958 (gdb)
18959 @end smallexample
18960
18961
18962 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
18963 @findex -exec-step-instruction
18964
18965 @subsubheading Synopsis
18966
18967 @smallexample
18968 -exec-step-instruction
18969 @end smallexample
18970
18971 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
18972 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
18973 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
18974 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
18975 well.
18976
18977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18978
18979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
18980
18981 @subsubheading Example
18982
18983 @smallexample
18984 (gdb)
18985 -exec-step-instruction
18986 ^running
18987
18988 (gdb)
18989 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18990 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18991 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18992 (gdb)
18993 -exec-step-instruction
18994 ^running
18995
18996 (gdb)
18997 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18998 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18999 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19000 (gdb)
19001 @end smallexample
19002
19003
19004 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19005 @findex -exec-until
19006
19007 @subsubheading Synopsis
19008
19009 @smallexample
19010 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19011 @end smallexample
19012
19013 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19014 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19015 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19016 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19017
19018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19019
19020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19021
19022 @subsubheading Example
19023
19024 @smallexample
19025 (gdb)
19026 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19027 ^running
19028 (gdb)
19029 x = 55
19030 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19031 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19032 (gdb)
19033 @end smallexample
19034
19035 @ignore
19036 @subheading -file-clear
19037 Is this going away????
19038 @end ignore
19039
19040 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19041 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19042 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19043
19044
19045 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19046 @findex -stack-info-frame
19047
19048 @subsubheading Synopsis
19049
19050 @smallexample
19051 -stack-info-frame
19052 @end smallexample
19053
19054 Get info on the selected frame.
19055
19056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19057
19058 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19059 (without arguments).
19060
19061 @subsubheading Example
19062
19063 @smallexample
19064 (gdb)
19065 -stack-info-frame
19066 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19067 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19068 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19069 (gdb)
19070 @end smallexample
19071
19072 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19073 @findex -stack-info-depth
19074
19075 @subsubheading Synopsis
19076
19077 @smallexample
19078 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19079 @end smallexample
19080
19081 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19082 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19083
19084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19085
19086 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19087
19088 @subsubheading Example
19089
19090 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19091
19092 @smallexample
19093 (gdb)
19094 -stack-info-depth
19095 ^done,depth="12"
19096 (gdb)
19097 -stack-info-depth 4
19098 ^done,depth="4"
19099 (gdb)
19100 -stack-info-depth 12
19101 ^done,depth="12"
19102 (gdb)
19103 -stack-info-depth 11
19104 ^done,depth="11"
19105 (gdb)
19106 -stack-info-depth 13
19107 ^done,depth="12"
19108 (gdb)
19109 @end smallexample
19110
19111 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19112 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19113
19114 @subsubheading Synopsis
19115
19116 @smallexample
19117 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19118 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19119 @end smallexample
19120
19121 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19122 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19123 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
19124 stack.
19125
19126 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19127 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19128 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19129
19130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19131
19132 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19133 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19134 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19135
19136 @subsubheading Example
19137
19138 @smallexample
19139 (gdb)
19140 -stack-list-frames
19141 ^done,
19142 stack=[
19143 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19144 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19145 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19146 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19147 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19148 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19149 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19150 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19151 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19152 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19153 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19154 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19155 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19156 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19157 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19158 (gdb)
19159 -stack-list-arguments 0
19160 ^done,
19161 stack-args=[
19162 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19163 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19164 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19165 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19166 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19167 (gdb)
19168 -stack-list-arguments 1
19169 ^done,
19170 stack-args=[
19171 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19172 frame=@{level="1",
19173 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19174 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19175 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19176 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19177 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19178 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19179 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19180 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19181 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19182 (gdb)
19183 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19184 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19185 (gdb)
19186 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19187 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19188 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19189 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19190 (gdb)
19191 @end smallexample
19192
19193 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19194
19195
19196 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19197 @findex -stack-list-frames
19198
19199 @subsubheading Synopsis
19200
19201 @smallexample
19202 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19203 @end smallexample
19204
19205 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19206 following info:
19207
19208 @table @samp
19209 @item @var{level}
19210 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19211 @item @var{addr}
19212 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19213 @item @var{func}
19214 Function name.
19215 @item @var{file}
19216 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19217 @item @var{line}
19218 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19219 @end table
19220
19221 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19222 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19223 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19224 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
19225
19226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19227
19228 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19229
19230 @subsubheading Example
19231
19232 Full stack backtrace:
19233
19234 @smallexample
19235 (gdb)
19236 -stack-list-frames
19237 ^done,stack=
19238 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19239 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19240 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19241 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19242 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19243 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19244 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19245 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19246 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19247 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19248 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19249 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19250 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19251 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19252 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19253 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19254 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19255 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19256 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19257 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19258 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19259 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19260 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19261 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19262 (gdb)
19263 @end smallexample
19264
19265 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19266
19267 @smallexample
19268 (gdb)
19269 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19270 ^done,stack=
19271 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19272 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19273 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19274 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19275 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19276 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19277 (gdb)
19278 @end smallexample
19279
19280 Show a single frame:
19281
19282 @smallexample
19283 (gdb)
19284 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19285 ^done,stack=
19286 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19287 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19288 (gdb)
19289 @end smallexample
19290
19291
19292 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19293 @findex -stack-list-locals
19294
19295 @subsubheading Synopsis
19296
19297 @smallexample
19298 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19299 @end smallexample
19300
19301 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19302 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19303 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19304 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19305 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19306 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19307 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19308 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19309 more detail.
19310
19311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19312
19313 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19314
19315 @subsubheading Example
19316
19317 @smallexample
19318 (gdb)
19319 -stack-list-locals 0
19320 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19321 (gdb)
19322 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19323 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19324 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19325 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19326 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19327 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19328 (gdb)
19329 @end smallexample
19330
19331
19332 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19333 @findex -stack-select-frame
19334
19335 @subsubheading Synopsis
19336
19337 @smallexample
19338 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19339 @end smallexample
19340
19341 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19342 the stack.
19343
19344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19345
19346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19347 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19348
19349 @subsubheading Example
19350
19351 @smallexample
19352 (gdb)
19353 -stack-select-frame 2
19354 ^done
19355 (gdb)
19356 @end smallexample
19357
19358 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19359 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19360 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19361
19362
19363 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19364
19365 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19366 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19367 used by @code{Insight}.
19368
19369 The two main reasons for that are:
19370
19371 @enumerate 1
19372 @item
19373 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19374
19375 @item
19376 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19377 now).
19378 @end enumerate
19379
19380 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19381 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19382 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19383 hints about their use.
19384
19385 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19386 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19387 least, the following operations:
19388
19389 @itemize @bullet
19390 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19391 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19392 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19393 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19394 @end itemize
19395
19396 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19397
19398 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19399 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
19400 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
19401 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
19402 examining or changing its properties.
19403
19404 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
19405 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
19406 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
19407 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
19408 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
19409
19410 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
19411 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
19412 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
19413 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
19414 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19415 for pointers, etc.).
19416
19417 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19418 access this functionality:
19419
19420 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19421 @item @strong{Operation}
19422 @tab @strong{Description}
19423
19424 @item @code{-var-create}
19425 @tab create a variable object
19426 @item @code{-var-delete}
19427 @tab delete the variable object and its children
19428 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19429 @tab set the display format of this variable
19430 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19431 @tab show the display format of this variable
19432 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19433 @tab tells how many children this object has
19434 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19435 @tab return a list of the object's children
19436 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19437 @tab show the type of this variable object
19438 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19439 @tab print what this variable object represents
19440 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19441 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19442 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19443 @tab get the value of this variable
19444 @item @code{-var-assign}
19445 @tab set the value of this variable
19446 @item @code{-var-update}
19447 @tab update the variable and its children
19448 @end multitable
19449
19450 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19451 how it can be used.
19452
19453 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19454
19455 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19456 @findex -var-create
19457
19458 @subsubheading Synopsis
19459
19460 @smallexample
19461 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19462 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19463 @end smallexample
19464
19465 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19466 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19467 register.
19468
19469 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19470 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19471 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19472 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19473 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19474
19475 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19476 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19477 frame should be used.
19478
19479 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19480 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19481
19482 @itemize @bullet
19483 @item
19484 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19485
19486 @item
19487 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19488
19489 @item
19490 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19491 @end itemize
19492
19493 @subsubheading Result
19494
19495 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19496 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19497 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19498
19499 @smallexample
19500 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19501 @end smallexample
19502
19503
19504 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19505 @findex -var-delete
19506
19507 @subsubheading Synopsis
19508
19509 @smallexample
19510 -var-delete @var{name}
19511 @end smallexample
19512
19513 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19514
19515 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19516
19517
19518 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19519 @findex -var-set-format
19520
19521 @subsubheading Synopsis
19522
19523 @smallexample
19524 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19525 @end smallexample
19526
19527 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19528 @var{format-spec}.
19529
19530 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19531
19532 @smallexample
19533 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19534 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19535 @end smallexample
19536
19537
19538 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19539 @findex -var-show-format
19540
19541 @subsubheading Synopsis
19542
19543 @smallexample
19544 -var-show-format @var{name}
19545 @end smallexample
19546
19547 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19548
19549 @smallexample
19550 @var{format} @expansion{}
19551 @var{format-spec}
19552 @end smallexample
19553
19554
19555 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19556 @findex -var-info-num-children
19557
19558 @subsubheading Synopsis
19559
19560 @smallexample
19561 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19562 @end smallexample
19563
19564 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19565
19566 @smallexample
19567 numchild=@var{n}
19568 @end smallexample
19569
19570
19571 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19572 @findex -var-list-children
19573
19574 @subsubheading Synopsis
19575
19576 @smallexample
19577 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19578 @end smallexample
19579 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19580
19581 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19582 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19583 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19584 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19585 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19586 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19587 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19588 and unions.
19589
19590 @subsubheading Example
19591
19592 @smallexample
19593 (gdb)
19594 -var-list-children n
19595 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19596 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19597 (gdb)
19598 -var-list-children --all-values n
19599 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19600 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19601 @end smallexample
19602
19603
19604 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19605 @findex -var-info-type
19606
19607 @subsubheading Synopsis
19608
19609 @smallexample
19610 -var-info-type @var{name}
19611 @end smallexample
19612
19613 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19614 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19615 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19616
19617 @smallexample
19618 type=@var{typename}
19619 @end smallexample
19620
19621
19622 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19623 @findex -var-info-expression
19624
19625 @subsubheading Synopsis
19626
19627 @smallexample
19628 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19629 @end smallexample
19630
19631 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19632
19633 @smallexample
19634 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19635 @end smallexample
19636
19637 @noindent
19638 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19639
19640 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19641 @findex -var-show-attributes
19642
19643 @subsubheading Synopsis
19644
19645 @smallexample
19646 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19647 @end smallexample
19648
19649 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19650
19651 @smallexample
19652 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19653 @end smallexample
19654
19655 @noindent
19656 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19657
19658 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19659 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19660
19661 @subsubheading Synopsis
19662
19663 @smallexample
19664 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19665 @end smallexample
19666
19667 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19668 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
19669 for the object:
19670
19671 @smallexample
19672 value=@var{value}
19673 @end smallexample
19674
19675 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19676 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19677
19678 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19679 @findex -var-assign
19680
19681 @subsubheading Synopsis
19682
19683 @smallexample
19684 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19685 @end smallexample
19686
19687 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19688 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19689 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19690 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19691
19692 @subsubheading Example
19693
19694 @smallexample
19695 (gdb)
19696 -var-assign var1 3
19697 ^done,value="3"
19698 (gdb)
19699 -var-update *
19700 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19701 (gdb)
19702 @end smallexample
19703
19704 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19705 @findex -var-update
19706
19707 @subsubheading Synopsis
19708
19709 @smallexample
19710 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19711 @end smallexample
19712
19713 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
19714 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
19715 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
19716 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
19717 just names are printed in the manner described for
19718 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
19719
19720 @subsubheading Example
19721
19722 @smallexample
19723 (gdb)
19724 -var-assign var1 3
19725 ^done,value="3"
19726 (gdb)
19727 -var-update --all-values var1
19728 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19729 type_changed="false"@}]
19730 (gdb)
19731 @end smallexample
19732
19733 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19734 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19735 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19736
19737 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19738 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19739 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19740 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19741
19742 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19743 @c @subheading -data-assign
19744 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19745 @c @subsubheading GDB command
19746 @c set variable
19747 @c @subsubheading Example
19748 @c N.A.
19749
19750 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19751 @findex -data-disassemble
19752
19753 @subsubheading Synopsis
19754
19755 @smallexample
19756 -data-disassemble
19757 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19758 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19759 -- @var{mode}
19760 @end smallexample
19761
19762 @noindent
19763 Where:
19764
19765 @table @samp
19766 @item @var{start-addr}
19767 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19768 @item @var{end-addr}
19769 is the end address
19770 @item @var{filename}
19771 is the name of the file to disassemble
19772 @item @var{linenum}
19773 is the line number to disassemble around
19774 @item @var{lines}
19775 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19776 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19777 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19778 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19779 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19780 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19781 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19782 are displayed.
19783 @item @var{mode}
19784 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19785 disassembly).
19786 @end table
19787
19788 @subsubheading Result
19789
19790 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19791
19792 @itemize @bullet
19793 @item Address
19794 @item Func-name
19795 @item Offset
19796 @item Instruction
19797 @end itemize
19798
19799 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19800 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
19801
19802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19803
19804 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19805
19806 @subsubheading Example
19807
19808 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19809
19810 @smallexample
19811 (gdb)
19812 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19813 ^done,
19814 asm_insns=[
19815 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19816 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19817 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19818 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19819 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19820 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19821 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19822 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19823 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19824 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19825 (gdb)
19826 @end smallexample
19827
19828 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19829 @code{main}.
19830
19831 @smallexample
19832 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19833 ^done,asm_insns=[
19834 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19835 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19836 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19837 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19838 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19839 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19840 [@dots{}]
19841 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19842 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19843 (gdb)
19844 @end smallexample
19845
19846 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19847
19848 @smallexample
19849 (gdb)
19850 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19851 ^done,asm_insns=[
19852 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19853 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19854 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19855 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19856 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19857 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
19858 (gdb)
19859 @end smallexample
19860
19861 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
19862
19863 @smallexample
19864 (gdb)
19865 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
19866 ^done,asm_insns=[
19867 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
19868 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19869 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19870 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19871 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
19872 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
19873 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19874 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19875 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19876 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19877 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19878 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
19879 (gdb)
19880 @end smallexample
19881
19882
19883 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
19884 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
19885
19886 @subsubheading Synopsis
19887
19888 @smallexample
19889 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
19890 @end smallexample
19891
19892 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
19893 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
19894 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
19895
19896 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19897
19898 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
19899 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
19900 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
19901
19902 @subsubheading Example
19903
19904 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
19905 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
19906 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
19907 output.
19908
19909 @smallexample
19910 211-data-evaluate-expression A
19911 211^done,value="1"
19912 (gdb)
19913 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
19914 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
19915 (gdb)
19916 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
19917 411^done,value="4"
19918 (gdb)
19919 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
19920 511^done,value="4"
19921 (gdb)
19922 @end smallexample
19923
19924
19925 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
19926 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
19927
19928 @subsubheading Synopsis
19929
19930 @smallexample
19931 -data-list-changed-registers
19932 @end smallexample
19933
19934 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
19935
19936 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19937
19938 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
19939 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
19940
19941 @subsubheading Example
19942
19943 On a PPC MBX board:
19944
19945 @smallexample
19946 (gdb)
19947 -exec-continue
19948 ^running
19949
19950 (gdb)
19951 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
19952 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
19953 (gdb)
19954 -data-list-changed-registers
19955 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
19956 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
19957 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
19958 (gdb)
19959 @end smallexample
19960
19961
19962 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
19963 @findex -data-list-register-names
19964
19965 @subsubheading Synopsis
19966
19967 @smallexample
19968 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
19969 @end smallexample
19970
19971 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
19972 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
19973 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
19974 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
19975 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
19976 include empty register names.
19977
19978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19979
19980 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
19981 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
19982 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
19983
19984 @subsubheading Example
19985
19986 For the PPC MBX board:
19987 @smallexample
19988 (gdb)
19989 -data-list-register-names
19990 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
19991 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
19992 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
19993 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
19994 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
19995 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
19996 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
19997 (gdb)
19998 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
19999 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20000 (gdb)
20001 @end smallexample
20002
20003 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20004 @findex -data-list-register-values
20005
20006 @subsubheading Synopsis
20007
20008 @smallexample
20009 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20010 @end smallexample
20011
20012 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20013 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20014 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20015 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20016
20017 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20018
20019 @table @code
20020 @item x
20021 Hexadecimal
20022 @item o
20023 Octal
20024 @item t
20025 Binary
20026 @item d
20027 Decimal
20028 @item r
20029 Raw
20030 @item N
20031 Natural
20032 @end table
20033
20034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20035
20036 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20037 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20038
20039 @subsubheading Example
20040
20041 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20042 don't appear in the actual output):
20043
20044 @smallexample
20045 (gdb)
20046 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20047 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20048 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20049 (gdb)
20050 -data-list-register-values x
20051 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20052 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20053 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20054 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20055 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20056 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20057 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20058 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20059 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20060 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20061 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20062 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20063 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20064 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20065 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20066 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20067 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20068 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20069 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20070 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20071 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20072 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20073 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20074 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20075 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20076 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20077 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20078 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20079 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20080 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20081 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20082 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20083 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20084 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20085 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20086 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20087 (gdb)
20088 @end smallexample
20089
20090
20091 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20092 @findex -data-read-memory
20093
20094 @subsubheading Synopsis
20095
20096 @smallexample
20097 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20098 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20099 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20100 @end smallexample
20101
20102 @noindent
20103 where:
20104
20105 @table @samp
20106 @item @var{address}
20107 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20108 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20109 quoted using the C convention.
20110
20111 @item @var{word-format}
20112 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20113 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20114 ,Output formats}).
20115
20116 @item @var{word-size}
20117 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20118
20119 @item @var{nr-rows}
20120 The number of rows in the output table.
20121
20122 @item @var{nr-cols}
20123 The number of columns in the output table.
20124
20125 @item @var{aschar}
20126 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20127 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20128 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20129 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20130
20131 @item @var{byte-offset}
20132 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20133 @end table
20134
20135 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20136 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20137 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20138 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20139 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20140 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20141 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20142 @samp{addr}.
20143
20144 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20145 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20146 @samp{prev-page}.
20147
20148 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20149
20150 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20151 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20152
20153 @subsubheading Example
20154
20155 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20156 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20157 word. Display each word in hex.
20158
20159 @smallexample
20160 (gdb)
20161 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20162 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20163 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20164 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20165 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20166 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20167 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20168 (gdb)
20169 @end smallexample
20170
20171 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20172 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20173
20174 @smallexample
20175 (gdb)
20176 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20177 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20178 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20179 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20180 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20181 (gdb)
20182 @end smallexample
20183
20184 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20185 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20186 used as the non-printable character.
20187
20188 @smallexample
20189 (gdb)
20190 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20191 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20192 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20193 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20194 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20195 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20196 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20197 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20198 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20199 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20200 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20201 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20202 (gdb)
20203 @end smallexample
20204
20205 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20206 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20207 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20208
20209 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20210
20211 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20212
20213 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20214
20215 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20216
20217 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20218
20219 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20220
20221 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20222
20223 @c @subheading -trace-find
20224
20225 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20226
20227 @c @subheading -trace-info
20228
20229 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20230
20231 @c @subheading -trace-list
20232
20233 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20234
20235 @c @subheading -trace-save
20236
20237 @c @subheading -trace-start
20238
20239 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20240
20241
20242 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20243 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20244 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20245
20246
20247 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20248 @findex -symbol-info-address
20249
20250 @subsubheading Synopsis
20251
20252 @smallexample
20253 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20254 @end smallexample
20255
20256 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20257
20258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20259
20260 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20261
20262 @subsubheading Example
20263 N.A.
20264
20265
20266 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20267 @findex -symbol-info-file
20268
20269 @subsubheading Synopsis
20270
20271 @smallexample
20272 -symbol-info-file
20273 @end smallexample
20274
20275 Show the file for the symbol.
20276
20277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20278
20279 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20280 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20281
20282 @subsubheading Example
20283 N.A.
20284
20285
20286 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20287 @findex -symbol-info-function
20288
20289 @subsubheading Synopsis
20290
20291 @smallexample
20292 -symbol-info-function
20293 @end smallexample
20294
20295 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20296
20297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20298
20299 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20300
20301 @subsubheading Example
20302 N.A.
20303
20304
20305 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20306 @findex -symbol-info-line
20307
20308 @subsubheading Synopsis
20309
20310 @smallexample
20311 -symbol-info-line
20312 @end smallexample
20313
20314 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20315
20316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20317
20318 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20319 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20320
20321 @subsubheading Example
20322 N.A.
20323
20324
20325 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20326 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20327
20328 @subsubheading Synopsis
20329
20330 @smallexample
20331 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20332 @end smallexample
20333
20334 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20335
20336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20337
20338 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20339
20340 @subsubheading Example
20341 N.A.
20342
20343
20344 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20345 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20346
20347 @subsubheading Synopsis
20348
20349 @smallexample
20350 -symbol-list-functions
20351 @end smallexample
20352
20353 List the functions in the executable.
20354
20355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20356
20357 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20358 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20359
20360 @subsubheading Example
20361 N.A.
20362
20363
20364 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20365 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20366
20367 @subsubheading Synopsis
20368
20369 @smallexample
20370 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20371 @end smallexample
20372
20373 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20374 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20375 ascending PC order.
20376
20377 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20378
20379 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20380
20381 @subsubheading Example
20382 @smallexample
20383 (gdb)
20384 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20385 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20386 (gdb)
20387 @end smallexample
20388
20389
20390 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20391 @findex -symbol-list-types
20392
20393 @subsubheading Synopsis
20394
20395 @smallexample
20396 -symbol-list-types
20397 @end smallexample
20398
20399 List all the type names.
20400
20401 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20402
20403 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20404 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20405
20406 @subsubheading Example
20407 N.A.
20408
20409
20410 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20411 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20412
20413 @subsubheading Synopsis
20414
20415 @smallexample
20416 -symbol-list-variables
20417 @end smallexample
20418
20419 List all the global and static variable names.
20420
20421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20422
20423 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20424
20425 @subsubheading Example
20426 N.A.
20427
20428
20429 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20430 @findex -symbol-locate
20431
20432 @subsubheading Synopsis
20433
20434 @smallexample
20435 -symbol-locate
20436 @end smallexample
20437
20438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20439
20440 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20441
20442 @subsubheading Example
20443 N.A.
20444
20445
20446 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20447 @findex -symbol-type
20448
20449 @subsubheading Synopsis
20450
20451 @smallexample
20452 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20453 @end smallexample
20454
20455 Show type of @var{variable}.
20456
20457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20458
20459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20460 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20461
20462 @subsubheading Example
20463 N.A.
20464
20465
20466 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20467 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20468 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20469
20470 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20471 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20472
20473 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20474 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20475
20476 @subsubheading Synopsis
20477
20478 @smallexample
20479 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20480 @end smallexample
20481
20482 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20483 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20484 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20485 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20486 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20487 notification.
20488
20489 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20490
20491 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20492
20493 @subsubheading Example
20494
20495 @smallexample
20496 (gdb)
20497 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20498 ^done
20499 (gdb)
20500 @end smallexample
20501
20502
20503 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20504 @findex -file-exec-file
20505
20506 @subsubheading Synopsis
20507
20508 @smallexample
20509 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20510 @end smallexample
20511
20512 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20513 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20514 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20515 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20516 notification.
20517
20518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20519
20520 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20521
20522 @subsubheading Example
20523
20524 @smallexample
20525 (gdb)
20526 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20527 ^done
20528 (gdb)
20529 @end smallexample
20530
20531
20532 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20533 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20534
20535 @subsubheading Synopsis
20536
20537 @smallexample
20538 -file-list-exec-sections
20539 @end smallexample
20540
20541 List the sections of the current executable file.
20542
20543 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20544
20545 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20546 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20547 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20548
20549 @subsubheading Example
20550 N.A.
20551
20552
20553 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20554 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20555
20556 @subsubheading Synopsis
20557
20558 @smallexample
20559 -file-list-exec-source-file
20560 @end smallexample
20561
20562 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20563 to the current source file for the current executable.
20564
20565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20566
20567 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20568
20569 @subsubheading Example
20570
20571 @smallexample
20572 (gdb)
20573 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20574 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20575 (gdb)
20576 @end smallexample
20577
20578
20579 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20580 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20581
20582 @subsubheading Synopsis
20583
20584 @smallexample
20585 -file-list-exec-source-files
20586 @end smallexample
20587
20588 List the source files for the current executable.
20589
20590 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
20591 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20592
20593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20594
20595 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20596 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20597
20598 @subsubheading Example
20599 @smallexample
20600 (gdb)
20601 -file-list-exec-source-files
20602 ^done,files=[
20603 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20604 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20605 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20606 (gdb)
20607 @end smallexample
20608
20609 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20610 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20611
20612 @subsubheading Synopsis
20613
20614 @smallexample
20615 -file-list-shared-libraries
20616 @end smallexample
20617
20618 List the shared libraries in the program.
20619
20620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20621
20622 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20623
20624 @subsubheading Example
20625 N.A.
20626
20627
20628 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20629 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20630
20631 @subsubheading Synopsis
20632
20633 @smallexample
20634 -file-list-symbol-files
20635 @end smallexample
20636
20637 List symbol files.
20638
20639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20640
20641 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20642
20643 @subsubheading Example
20644 N.A.
20645
20646
20647 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20648 @findex -file-symbol-file
20649
20650 @subsubheading Synopsis
20651
20652 @smallexample
20653 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20654 @end smallexample
20655
20656 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20657 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20658 produced, except for a completion notification.
20659
20660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20661
20662 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20663
20664 @subsubheading Example
20665
20666 @smallexample
20667 (gdb)
20668 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20669 ^done
20670 (gdb)
20671 @end smallexample
20672
20673 @ignore
20674 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20675 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20676 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20677
20678 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20679
20680 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20681
20682 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20683
20684 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20685
20686 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20687
20688 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20689
20690 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20691
20692 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20693
20694 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20695 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20696 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20697
20698 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20699
20700 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20701
20702 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20703
20704 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20705 @end ignore
20706
20707
20708 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20709 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20710 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20711
20712
20713 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20714 @findex -target-attach
20715
20716 @subsubheading Synopsis
20717
20718 @smallexample
20719 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20720 @end smallexample
20721
20722 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20723
20724 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20725
20726 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20727
20728 @subsubheading Example
20729 N.A.
20730
20731
20732 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20733 @findex -target-compare-sections
20734
20735 @subsubheading Synopsis
20736
20737 @smallexample
20738 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20739 @end smallexample
20740
20741 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20742 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20743
20744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20745
20746 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20747
20748 @subsubheading Example
20749 N.A.
20750
20751
20752 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20753 @findex -target-detach
20754
20755 @subsubheading Synopsis
20756
20757 @smallexample
20758 -target-detach
20759 @end smallexample
20760
20761 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20762 There's no output.
20763
20764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20765
20766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20767
20768 @subsubheading Example
20769
20770 @smallexample
20771 (gdb)
20772 -target-detach
20773 ^done
20774 (gdb)
20775 @end smallexample
20776
20777
20778 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20779 @findex -target-disconnect
20780
20781 @subsubheading Synopsis
20782
20783 @example
20784 -target-disconnect
20785 @end example
20786
20787 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20788 generally not resumed.
20789
20790 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20791
20792 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20793
20794 @subsubheading Example
20795
20796 @smallexample
20797 (gdb)
20798 -target-disconnect
20799 ^done
20800 (gdb)
20801 @end smallexample
20802
20803
20804 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20805 @findex -target-download
20806
20807 @subsubheading Synopsis
20808
20809 @smallexample
20810 -target-download
20811 @end smallexample
20812
20813 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20814 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20815
20816 @table @samp
20817 @item section
20818 The name of the section.
20819 @item section-sent
20820 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20821 @item section-size
20822 The size of the section.
20823 @item total-sent
20824 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20825 @item total-size
20826 The size of the overall executable to download.
20827 @end table
20828
20829 @noindent
20830 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20831 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20832
20833 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20834 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20835
20836 @table @samp
20837 @item section
20838 The name of the section.
20839 @item section-size
20840 The size of the section.
20841 @item total-size
20842 The size of the overall executable to download.
20843 @end table
20844
20845 @noindent
20846 At the end, a summary is printed.
20847
20848 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20849
20850 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20851
20852 @subsubheading Example
20853
20854 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20855 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20856
20857 @smallexample
20858 (gdb)
20859 -target-download
20860 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20861 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20862 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20863 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20864 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20865 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20866 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20867 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20868 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20869 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20870 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20871 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20872 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20873 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20874 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20875 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20876 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
20877 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
20878 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
20879 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
20880 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
20881 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
20882 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
20883 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
20884 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
20885 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
20886 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
20887 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20888 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20889 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
20890 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
20891 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
20892 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
20893 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
20894 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
20895 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
20896 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
20897 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
20898 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
20899 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
20900 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
20901 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
20902 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
20903 write-rate="429"
20904 (gdb)
20905 @end smallexample
20906
20907
20908 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
20909 @findex -target-exec-status
20910
20911 @subsubheading Synopsis
20912
20913 @smallexample
20914 -target-exec-status
20915 @end smallexample
20916
20917 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
20918 not, for instance).
20919
20920 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20921
20922 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20923
20924 @subsubheading Example
20925 N.A.
20926
20927
20928 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
20929 @findex -target-list-available-targets
20930
20931 @subsubheading Synopsis
20932
20933 @smallexample
20934 -target-list-available-targets
20935 @end smallexample
20936
20937 List the possible targets to connect to.
20938
20939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20940
20941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
20942
20943 @subsubheading Example
20944 N.A.
20945
20946
20947 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
20948 @findex -target-list-current-targets
20949
20950 @subsubheading Synopsis
20951
20952 @smallexample
20953 -target-list-current-targets
20954 @end smallexample
20955
20956 Describe the current target.
20957
20958 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20959
20960 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
20961 other things).
20962
20963 @subsubheading Example
20964 N.A.
20965
20966
20967 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
20968 @findex -target-list-parameters
20969
20970 @subsubheading Synopsis
20971
20972 @smallexample
20973 -target-list-parameters
20974 @end smallexample
20975
20976 @c ????
20977
20978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20979
20980 No equivalent.
20981
20982 @subsubheading Example
20983 N.A.
20984
20985
20986 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
20987 @findex -target-select
20988
20989 @subsubheading Synopsis
20990
20991 @smallexample
20992 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
20993 @end smallexample
20994
20995 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
20996
20997 @table @samp
20998 @item @var{type}
20999 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21000 @item @var{parameters}
21001 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21002 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
21003 @end table
21004
21005 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21006 which the target program is, in the following form:
21007
21008 @smallexample
21009 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21010 args=[@var{arg list}]
21011 @end smallexample
21012
21013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21014
21015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21016
21017 @subsubheading Example
21018
21019 @smallexample
21020 (gdb)
21021 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21022 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21023 (gdb)
21024 @end smallexample
21025
21026 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21027 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21028 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21029
21030 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21031
21032 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21033 @findex -gdb-exit
21034
21035 @subsubheading Synopsis
21036
21037 @smallexample
21038 -gdb-exit
21039 @end smallexample
21040
21041 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21042
21043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21044
21045 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21046
21047 @subsubheading Example
21048
21049 @smallexample
21050 (gdb)
21051 -gdb-exit
21052 ^exit
21053 @end smallexample
21054
21055
21056 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21057 @findex -exec-abort
21058
21059 @subsubheading Synopsis
21060
21061 @smallexample
21062 -exec-abort
21063 @end smallexample
21064
21065 Kill the inferior running program.
21066
21067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21068
21069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21070
21071 @subsubheading Example
21072 N.A.
21073
21074
21075 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21076 @findex -gdb-set
21077
21078 @subsubheading Synopsis
21079
21080 @smallexample
21081 -gdb-set
21082 @end smallexample
21083
21084 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21085 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21086
21087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21088
21089 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21090
21091 @subsubheading Example
21092
21093 @smallexample
21094 (gdb)
21095 -gdb-set $foo=3
21096 ^done
21097 (gdb)
21098 @end smallexample
21099
21100
21101 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21102 @findex -gdb-show
21103
21104 @subsubheading Synopsis
21105
21106 @smallexample
21107 -gdb-show
21108 @end smallexample
21109
21110 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21111
21112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21113
21114 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21115
21116 @subsubheading Example
21117
21118 @smallexample
21119 (gdb)
21120 -gdb-show annotate
21121 ^done,value="0"
21122 (gdb)
21123 @end smallexample
21124
21125 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21126
21127
21128 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21129 @findex -gdb-version
21130
21131 @subsubheading Synopsis
21132
21133 @smallexample
21134 -gdb-version
21135 @end smallexample
21136
21137 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21138
21139 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21140
21141 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21142 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21143
21144 @subsubheading Example
21145
21146 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21147 @c box in TeX.
21148 @smallexample
21149 (gdb)
21150 -gdb-version
21151 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21152 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21153 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21154 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21155 ~ certain conditions.
21156 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21157 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21158 ~ details.
21159 ~This GDB was configured as
21160 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21161 ^done
21162 (gdb)
21163 @end smallexample
21164
21165 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21166 @findex -interpreter-exec
21167
21168 @subheading Synopsis
21169
21170 @smallexample
21171 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21172 @end smallexample
21173 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21174
21175 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21176
21177 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21178
21179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21180
21181 @subheading Example
21182
21183 @smallexample
21184 (gdb)
21185 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21186 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21187 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21188 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21189 ^done
21190 (gdb)
21191 @end smallexample
21192
21193 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21194 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21195
21196 @subheading Synopsis
21197
21198 @smallexample
21199 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21200 @end smallexample
21201
21202 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21203
21204 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21205
21206 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21207
21208 @subheading Example
21209
21210 @smallexample
21211 (gdb)
21212 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21213 ^done
21214 (gdb)
21215 @end smallexample
21216
21217 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21218 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21219
21220 @subheading Synopsis
21221
21222 @smallexample
21223 -inferior-tty-show
21224 @end smallexample
21225
21226 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21227
21228 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21229
21230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21231
21232 @subheading Example
21233
21234 @smallexample
21235 (gdb)
21236 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21237 ^done
21238 (gdb)
21239 -inferior-tty-show
21240 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21241 (gdb)
21242 @end smallexample
21243
21244 @node Annotations
21245 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21246
21247 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21248 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21249 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21250 relatively high level.
21251
21252 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21253 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21254
21255 @ignore
21256 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21257 @end ignore
21258
21259 @menu
21260 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21261 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21262 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21263 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21264 * Annotations for Running::
21265 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21266 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21267 @end menu
21268
21269 @node Annotations Overview
21270 @section What is an Annotation?
21271 @cindex annotations
21272
21273 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21274 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21275 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21276 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21277 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21278 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21279 cannot contain newline characters.
21280
21281 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21282 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21283 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21284 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21285 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21286 means those three characters as output.
21287
21288 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21289 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21290 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21291 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21292 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21293 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21294 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21295 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21296 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21297
21298 @table @code
21299 @kindex set annotate
21300 @item set annotate @var{level}
21301 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21302 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21303
21304 @item show annotate
21305 @kindex show annotate
21306 Show the current annotation level.
21307 @end table
21308
21309 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21310
21311 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21312
21313 @smallexample
21314 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21315 GNU gdb 6.0
21316 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21317 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21318 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21319 under certain conditions.
21320 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21321 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21322 for details.
21323 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21324
21325 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21326 (@value{GDBP})
21327 ^Z^Zprompt
21328 @kbd{quit}
21329
21330 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21331 $
21332 @end smallexample
21333
21334 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21335 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21336 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21337 output from @value{GDBN}.
21338
21339 @node Prompting
21340 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21341
21342 @cindex annotations for prompts
21343 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21344 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21345 over, etc.
21346
21347 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21348 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21349 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21350 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21351 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21352 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21353 features the following annotations:
21354
21355 @smallexample
21356 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21357 ^Z^Zprompt
21358 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21359 @end smallexample
21360
21361 The input types are
21362
21363 @table @code
21364 @findex pre-prompt
21365 @findex prompt
21366 @findex post-prompt
21367 @item prompt
21368 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21369
21370 @findex pre-commands
21371 @findex commands
21372 @findex post-commands
21373 @item commands
21374 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21375 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21376
21377 @findex pre-overload-choice
21378 @findex overload-choice
21379 @findex post-overload-choice
21380 @item overload-choice
21381 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21382
21383 @findex pre-query
21384 @findex query
21385 @findex post-query
21386 @item query
21387 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21388
21389 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
21390 @findex prompt-for-continue
21391 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
21392 @item prompt-for-continue
21393 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21394 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21395 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21396 presence of annotations.
21397 @end table
21398
21399 @node Errors
21400 @section Errors
21401 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21402
21403 @findex quit
21404 @smallexample
21405 ^Z^Zquit
21406 @end smallexample
21407
21408 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21409
21410 @findex error
21411 @smallexample
21412 ^Z^Zerror
21413 @end smallexample
21414
21415 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21416
21417 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21418 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21419 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21420 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21421 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21422 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21423 to the top level.
21424
21425 @findex error-begin
21426 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21427
21428 @smallexample
21429 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21430 @end smallexample
21431
21432 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21433 message.
21434
21435 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21436 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21437 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21438
21439 @node Invalidation
21440 @section Invalidation Notices
21441
21442 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21443 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21444 changed.
21445
21446 @table @code
21447 @findex frames-invalid
21448 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21449
21450 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21451 have changed.
21452
21453 @findex breakpoints-invalid
21454 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21455
21456 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21457 deleted a breakpoint.
21458 @end table
21459
21460 @node Annotations for Running
21461 @section Running the Program
21462 @cindex annotations for running programs
21463
21464 @findex starting
21465 @findex stopping
21466 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21467 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21468
21469 @smallexample
21470 ^Z^Zstarting
21471 @end smallexample
21472
21473 is output. When the program stops,
21474
21475 @smallexample
21476 ^Z^Zstopped
21477 @end smallexample
21478
21479 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21480 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21481
21482 @table @code
21483 @findex exited
21484 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21485 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21486 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21487
21488 @findex signalled
21489 @findex signal-name
21490 @findex signal-name-end
21491 @findex signal-string
21492 @findex signal-string-end
21493 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21494 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21495 annotation continues:
21496
21497 @smallexample
21498 @var{intro-text}
21499 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21500 @var{name}
21501 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21502 @var{middle-text}
21503 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21504 @var{string}
21505 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21506 @var{end-text}
21507 @end smallexample
21508
21509 @noindent
21510 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21511 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21512 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21513 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21514 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21515
21516 @findex signal
21517 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21518 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21519 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21520 terminated with it.
21521
21522 @findex breakpoint
21523 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21524 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21525
21526 @findex watchpoint
21527 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21528 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21529 @end table
21530
21531 @node Source Annotations
21532 @section Displaying Source
21533 @cindex annotations for source display
21534
21535 @findex source
21536 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21537
21538 @smallexample
21539 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21540 @end smallexample
21541
21542 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21543 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21544 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21545 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21546 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21547 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21548 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21549 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21550 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21551 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21552 depend on the language).
21553
21554 @node GDB Bugs
21555 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21556 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21557 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21558
21559 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21560
21561 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21562 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21563 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21564 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21565
21566 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21567 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21568
21569 @menu
21570 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21571 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21572 @end menu
21573
21574 @node Bug Criteria
21575 @section Have you found a bug?
21576 @cindex bug criteria
21577
21578 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21579
21580 @itemize @bullet
21581 @cindex fatal signal
21582 @cindex debugger crash
21583 @cindex crash of debugger
21584 @item
21585 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21586 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21587
21588 @cindex error on valid input
21589 @item
21590 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21591 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21592 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21593
21594 @cindex invalid input
21595 @item
21596 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21597 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21598 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21599 for traditional practice''.
21600
21601 @item
21602 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21603 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21604 @end itemize
21605
21606 @node Bug Reporting
21607 @section How to report bugs
21608 @cindex bug reports
21609 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21610
21611 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21612 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21613 contact that organization first.
21614
21615 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21616 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21617 distribution.
21618 @c should add a web page ref...
21619
21620 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21621 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21622 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21623 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21624 be used.
21625
21626 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21627 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21628 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21629 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21630
21631 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21632 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21633 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21634 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21635 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21636 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21637 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21638 bug reports to the mailing list.
21639
21640 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21641 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21642 fact or leave it out, state it!
21643
21644 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21645 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21646 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21647 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21648 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21649 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21650 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21651 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21652 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21653
21654 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21655 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21656 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21657 self-contained.
21658
21659 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21660 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21661 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21662 bugs properly.
21663
21664 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21665
21666 @itemize @bullet
21667 @item
21668 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21669 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21670 version}.
21671
21672 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21673 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21674
21675 @item
21676 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21677 version number.
21678
21679 @item
21680 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21681 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21682
21683 @item
21684 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21685 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21686 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21687 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21688 compilers.
21689
21690 @item
21691 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21692 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21693 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21694 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21695
21696 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21697 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21698
21699 @item
21700 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21701 reproduce the bug.
21702
21703 @item
21704 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21705 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21706
21707 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21708 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21709 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21710 a chance to make a mistake.
21711
21712 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21713 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21714 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21715 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21716 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21717 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21718 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21719 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21720
21721 @pindex script
21722 @cindex recording a session script
21723 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21724 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21725 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21726 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21727
21728 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21729 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21730
21731 @item
21732 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21733 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21734 it by context, not by line number.
21735
21736 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21737 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21738
21739 @end itemize
21740
21741 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21742
21743 @itemize @bullet
21744 @item
21745 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21746
21747 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21748 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21749 changes will not affect it.
21750
21751 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21752 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21753 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21754 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21755
21756 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21757 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21758 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21759 less time, and so on.
21760
21761 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21762 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21763
21764 @item
21765 A patch for the bug.
21766
21767 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21768 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21769 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21770 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21771
21772 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21773 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21774 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21775 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21776
21777 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21778 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21779 help us to understand.
21780
21781 @item
21782 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21783
21784 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21785 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21786 @end itemize
21787
21788 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21789 @c and consists of the two following files:
21790 @c rluser.texinfo
21791 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21792 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21793 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21794 @include rluser.texi
21795 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21796
21797
21798 @node Formatting Documentation
21799 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21800
21801 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21802 @cindex reference card
21803 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21804 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21805 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21806 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21807 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21808 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21809
21810 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21811 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21812
21813 @smallexample
21814 make refcard.dvi
21815 @end smallexample
21816
21817 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21818 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21819 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21820 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21821 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21822
21823 @cindex documentation
21824
21825 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21826 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21827 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21828 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21829 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21830 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21831
21832 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21833 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21834 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21835 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21836 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21837 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21838 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21839 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21840
21841 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21842 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21843 @code{makeinfo}.
21844
21845 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21846 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21847 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21848
21849 @smallexample
21850 cd gdb
21851 make gdb.info
21852 @end smallexample
21853
21854 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21855 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21856 Texinfo definitions file.
21857
21858 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21859 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21860 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21861 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21862 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21863 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21864 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21865
21866 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21867 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21868 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21869 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21870 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21871 directory.
21872
21873 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21874 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
21875 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21876 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
21877
21878 @smallexample
21879 make gdb.dvi
21880 @end smallexample
21881
21882 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
21883
21884 @node Installing GDB
21885 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
21886 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
21887 @cindex installation
21888 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
21889
21890 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
21891 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
21892 build the @code{gdb} program.
21893 @iftex
21894 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
21895 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
21896 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
21897 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
21898 @end iftex
21899
21900 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
21901 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
21902 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
21903
21904 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
21905 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
21906
21907 @table @code
21908 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
21909 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
21910
21911 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
21912 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
21913
21914 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
21915 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
21916
21917 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
21918 @sc{gnu} include files
21919
21920 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
21921 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
21922
21923 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
21924 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
21925
21926 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
21927 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
21928
21929 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
21930 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
21931
21932 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
21933 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
21934 @end table
21935
21936 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
21937 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
21938 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
21939
21940 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
21941 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
21942 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
21943 argument.
21944
21945 For example:
21946
21947 @smallexample
21948 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21949 ./configure @var{host}
21950 make
21951 @end smallexample
21952
21953 @noindent
21954 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
21955 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
21956 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
21957 correct value by examining your system.)
21958
21959 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
21960 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
21961 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
21962 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
21963
21964 @need 750
21965 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
21966 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
21967 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
21968
21969 @smallexample
21970 sh configure @var{host}
21971 @end smallexample
21972
21973 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
21974 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
21975 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
21976 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
21977 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
21978
21979 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
21980 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
21981 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
21982 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
21983 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
21984 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
21985 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
21986 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
21987 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21988
21989 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
21990 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
21991 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
21992 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
21993 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
21994
21995 @menu
21996 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21997 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
21998 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
21999 @end menu
22000
22001 @node Separate Objdir
22002 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22003
22004 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22005 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22006 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22007 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22008 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22009 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22010 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22011 program specified there.
22012
22013 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
22014 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22015 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
22016 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
22017 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22018 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22019
22020 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22021 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22022
22023 @smallexample
22024 @group
22025 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22026 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22027 cd ../gdb-sun4
22028 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22029 make
22030 @end group
22031 @end smallexample
22032
22033 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22034 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22035 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22036 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22037 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22038 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22039
22040 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22041 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22042 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22043 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22044 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22045
22046 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22047 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22048 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22049 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22050 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22051 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
22052
22053 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22054 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22055 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22056
22057 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
22058 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22059 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22060 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22061 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22062
22063 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22064 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22065 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22066 with each other.
22067
22068 @node Config Names
22069 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
22070
22071 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
22072 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22073 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22074 of information in the following pattern:
22075
22076 @smallexample
22077 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22078 @end smallexample
22079
22080 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22081 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22082 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22083
22084 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22085 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22086 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22087 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22088 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22089 abbreviations---for example:
22090
22091 @smallexample
22092 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22093 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22094 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22095 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22096 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22097 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22098 % sh config.sub sun4
22099 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22100 % sh config.sub sun3
22101 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22102 % sh config.sub i986v
22103 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22104 @end smallexample
22105
22106 @noindent
22107 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22108 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22109
22110 @node Configure Options
22111 @section @code{configure} options
22112
22113 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
22114 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
22115 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22116 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
22117
22118 @smallexample
22119 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22120 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22121 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22122 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22123 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22124 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22125 @var{host}
22126 @end smallexample
22127
22128 @noindent
22129 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22130 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22131 @samp{--}.
22132
22133 @table @code
22134 @item --help
22135 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
22136
22137 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22138 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22139 @file{@var{dir}}.
22140
22141 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22142 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22143 @file{@var{dir}}.
22144
22145 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22146 @need 2000
22147 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22148 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22149 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22150 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22151 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22152 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22153 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22154 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22155 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22156 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22157 @var{dirname}.
22158
22159 @item --norecursion
22160 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22161 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22162
22163 @item --target=@var{target}
22164 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22165 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22166 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22167
22168 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22169
22170 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22171 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22172
22173 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22174 @end table
22175
22176 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22177 needed for special purposes only.
22178
22179 @node Maintenance Commands
22180 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22181 @cindex maintenance commands
22182 @cindex internal commands
22183
22184 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22185 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22186 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22187 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22188 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22189
22190 @table @code
22191 @kindex maint agent
22192 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22193 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22194 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22195 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22196
22197 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22198 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22199 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22200 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22201 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22202 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22203 is shown:
22204
22205 @table @code
22206 @item breakpoint
22207 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22208
22209 @item watchpoint
22210 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22211
22212 @item longjmp
22213 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22214 @code{longjmp} calls.
22215
22216 @item longjmp resume
22217 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22218
22219 @item until
22220 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22221
22222 @item finish
22223 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22224
22225 @item shlib events
22226 Shared library events.
22227
22228 @end table
22229
22230 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22231 @item maint check-symtabs
22232 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22233
22234 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22235 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22236 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22237
22238 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22239 @item maint cplus namespace
22240 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22241
22242 @kindex maint demangle
22243 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22244 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
22245
22246 @kindex maint deprecate
22247 @kindex maint undeprecate
22248 @cindex deprecated commands
22249 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22250 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22251 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22252 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22253 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22254 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22255 the replacement as part of the warning.
22256
22257 @kindex maint dump-me
22258 @item maint dump-me
22259 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22260 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22261 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22262 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22263
22264 @kindex maint internal-error
22265 @kindex maint internal-warning
22266 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22267 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22268 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22269 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22270 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22271 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22272 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22273 @value{GDBN} session.
22274
22275 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22276 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22277
22278 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
22279
22280 @smallexample
22281 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22282 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22283 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22284 debugging may prove unreliable.
22285 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22286 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22287 (@value{GDBP})
22288 @end smallexample
22289
22290 @kindex maint packet
22291 @item maint packet @var{text}
22292 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22293 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22294 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22295 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22296 checksum.
22297
22298 @kindex maint print architecture
22299 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22300 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22301 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22302
22303 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22304 @item maint print dummy-frames
22305 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22306
22307 @smallexample
22308 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22309 @dots{}
22310 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22311 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22312 58 return (a + b);
22313 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22314 @dots{}
22315 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22316 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22317 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22318 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22319 (@value{GDBP})
22320 @end smallexample
22321
22322 Takes an optional file parameter.
22323
22324 @kindex maint print registers
22325 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22326 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22327 @kindex maint print register-groups
22328 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22329 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22330 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22331 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22332 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22333
22334 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22335 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22336 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22337 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22338 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22339 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22340
22341 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22342 write the information.
22343
22344 @kindex maint print reggroups
22345 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22346 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22347 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22348 information.
22349
22350 The register groups info looks like this:
22351
22352 @smallexample
22353 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22354 Group Type
22355 general user
22356 float user
22357 all user
22358 vector user
22359 system user
22360 save internal
22361 restore internal
22362 @end smallexample
22363
22364 @kindex flushregs
22365 @item flushregs
22366 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22367
22368 @kindex maint print objfiles
22369 @cindex info for known object files
22370 @item maint print objfiles
22371 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22372 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22373 and symtabs.
22374
22375 @kindex maint print statistics
22376 @cindex bcache statistics
22377 @item maint print statistics
22378 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22379 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22380 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22381 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22382 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22383 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22384 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22385 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22386 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22387 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22388 lengths.
22389
22390 @kindex maint print type
22391 @cindex type chain of a data type
22392 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22393 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22394 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22395 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22396 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22397 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22398
22399 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22400 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22401 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22402 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22403 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22404
22405 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22406 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22407 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22408 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22409 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22410 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22411 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22412 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22413 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22414
22415 @kindex maint set profile
22416 @kindex maint show profile
22417 @cindex profiling GDB
22418 @item maint set profile
22419 @itemx maint show profile
22420 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22421
22422 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22423 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22424 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22425 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22426 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22427 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22428 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22429
22430 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22431 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22432
22433 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22434 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22435 @item maint show-debug-regs
22436 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22437 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22438 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22439 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22440 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22441
22442 @kindex maint space
22443 @cindex memory used by commands
22444 @item maint space
22445 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22446 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22447 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22448 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22449 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22450
22451 @kindex maint time
22452 @cindex time of command execution
22453 @item maint time
22454 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22455 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22456 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22457 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22458 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22459
22460 @kindex maint translate-address
22461 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22462 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22463 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22464 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22465 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22466 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22467 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22468
22469 @end table
22470
22471 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22472 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22473
22474 @table @code
22475 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22476 @kindex set watchdog
22477 @cindex watchdog timer
22478 @cindex timeout for commands
22479 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22480 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22481 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22482
22483 @item show watchdog
22484 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22485 @end table
22486
22487 @node Remote Protocol
22488 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22489
22490 @menu
22491 * Overview::
22492 * Packets::
22493 * Stop Reply Packets::
22494 * General Query Packets::
22495 * Register Packet Format::
22496 * Tracepoint Packets::
22497 * Interrupts::
22498 * Examples::
22499 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22500 @end menu
22501
22502 @node Overview
22503 @section Overview
22504
22505 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22506 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22507 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22508 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22509
22510 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22511 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22512
22513 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22514 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22515 @cindex remote serial protocol
22516 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22517 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22518 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22519 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22520
22521 @smallexample
22522 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22523 @end smallexample
22524 @noindent
22525
22526 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22527 @noindent
22528 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22529 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22530 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22531
22532 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22533 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22534
22535 @smallexample
22536 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22537 @end smallexample
22538
22539 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22540 @noindent
22541 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22542 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22543 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22544
22545 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22546 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22547 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22548 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22549 retransmission):
22550
22551 @smallexample
22552 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22553 <- @code{+}
22554 @end smallexample
22555 @noindent
22556
22557 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22558 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22559 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22560 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22561
22562 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22563 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22564 exceptions).
22565
22566 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22567 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22568 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22569 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22570
22571 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22572 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22573 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22574
22575 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22576 @anchor{Binary Data}
22577 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22578 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22579 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22580 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22581 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22582 binary data.
22583
22584 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22585 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22586 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22587 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22588 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22589 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22590 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22591 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22592 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22593 (described next).
22594
22595 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22596 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22597 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22598 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22599 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22600 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22601 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22602
22603 So:
22604 @smallexample
22605 "@code{0* }"
22606 @end smallexample
22607 @noindent
22608 means the same as "0000".
22609
22610 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22611 error number. That number is not well defined.
22612
22613 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22614 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22615 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22616 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22617 on that response.
22618
22619 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22620 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22621 optional.
22622
22623 @node Packets
22624 @section Packets
22625
22626 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22627 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22628 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22629 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22630
22631 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22632 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22633 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22634 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22635 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22636 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22637 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22638 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22639 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22640 @var{baz}.
22641
22642 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22643 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22644
22645 Here are the packet descriptions.
22646
22647 @table @samp
22648
22649 @item !
22650 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22651 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22652 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22653 debugged.
22654
22655 Reply:
22656 @table @samp
22657 @item OK
22658 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22659 @end table
22660
22661 @item ?
22662 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22663 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22664 step and continue.
22665
22666 Reply:
22667 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22668
22669 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22670 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22671 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22672 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22673 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22674
22675 Reply:
22676 @table @samp
22677 @item OK
22678 The arguments were set.
22679 @item E @var{NN}
22680 An error occurred.
22681 @end table
22682
22683 @item b @var{baud}
22684 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22685 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22686 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22687
22688 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22689 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22690 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22691
22692 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22693 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22694 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22695 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22696 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22697
22698 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22699 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22700 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22701 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22702
22703 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22704 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22705
22706 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22707 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22708 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22709 resume at current address.
22710
22711 Reply:
22712 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22713
22714 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22715 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22716 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22717 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22718
22719 Reply:
22720 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22721
22722 @item d
22723 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22724 Toggle debug flag.
22725
22726 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22727 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22728
22729 @item D
22730 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22731 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22732 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22733
22734 Reply:
22735 @table @samp
22736 @item OK
22737 for success
22738 @item E @var{NN}
22739 for an error
22740 @end table
22741
22742 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22743 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22744 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22745 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22746 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22747
22748 @item g
22749 @anchor{read registers packet}
22750 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22751 Read general registers.
22752
22753 Reply:
22754 @table @samp
22755 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22756 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22757 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22758 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22759 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22760 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22761 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22762 @item E @var{NN}
22763 for an error.
22764 @end table
22765
22766 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22767 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22768 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22769 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22770
22771 Reply:
22772 @table @samp
22773 @item OK
22774 for success
22775 @item E @var{NN}
22776 for an error
22777 @end table
22778
22779 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22780 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22781 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22782 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22783 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22784 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22785 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22786
22787 Reply:
22788 @table @samp
22789 @item OK
22790 for success
22791 @item E @var{NN}
22792 for an error
22793 @end table
22794
22795 @c FIXME: JTC:
22796 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22797 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22798 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22799 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22800 @c described. For example:
22801 @c
22802 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22803 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22804 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22805 @c
22806 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22807 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22808 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22809
22810 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22811 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22812 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22813 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22814 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22815 step starting at that address.
22816
22817 @item I
22818 @cindex @samp{I} packet
22819 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22820 step packet}.
22821
22822 @item k
22823 @cindex @samp{k} packet
22824 Kill request.
22825
22826 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22827 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22828 thread?)}.
22829
22830 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22831 @cindex @samp{m} packet
22832 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22833 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22834
22835 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22836 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22837 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22838 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
22839 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
22840 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
22841 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
22842 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
22843
22844 Reply:
22845 @table @samp
22846 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22847 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexidecimal
22848 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
22849 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
22850 @item E @var{NN}
22851 @var{NN} is errno
22852 @end table
22853
22854 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22855 @cindex @samp{M} packet
22856 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22857 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
22858 hexidecimal number.
22859
22860 Reply:
22861 @table @samp
22862 @item OK
22863 for success
22864 @item E @var{NN}
22865 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
22866 written).
22867 @end table
22868
22869 @item p @var{n}
22870 @cindex @samp{p} packet
22871 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
22872 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
22873 register value is encoded.
22874
22875 Reply:
22876 @table @samp
22877 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22878 the register's value
22879 @item E @var{NN}
22880 for an error
22881 @item
22882 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22883 @end table
22884
22885 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
22886 @anchor{write register packet}
22887 @cindex @samp{P} packet
22888 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
22889 number @var{n} is in hexidecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
22890 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
22891
22892 Reply:
22893 @table @samp
22894 @item OK
22895 for success
22896 @item E @var{NN}
22897 for an error
22898 @end table
22899
22900 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22901 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22902 @cindex @samp{q} packet
22903 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
22904 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
22905 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
22906
22907 @item r
22908 @cindex @samp{r} packet
22909 Reset the entire system.
22910
22911 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
22912
22913 @item R @var{XX}
22914 @cindex @samp{R} packet
22915 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
22916 This packet is only available in extended mode.
22917
22918 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
22919
22920 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22921 @cindex @samp{s} packet
22922 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
22923 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
22924
22925 Reply:
22926 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22927
22928 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22929 @anchor{step with signal packet}
22930 @cindex @samp{S} packet
22931 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
22932 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
22933
22934 Reply:
22935 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22936
22937 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
22938 @cindex @samp{t} packet
22939 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
22940 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
22941 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
22942
22943 @item T @var{XX}
22944 @cindex @samp{T} packet
22945 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
22946
22947 Reply:
22948 @table @samp
22949 @item OK
22950 thread is still alive
22951 @item E @var{NN}
22952 thread is dead
22953 @end table
22954
22955 @item v
22956 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
22957 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
22958
22959 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
22960 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
22961 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
22962 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
22963 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
22964 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
22965 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
22966 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
22967
22968 @table @samp
22969 @item c
22970 Continue.
22971 @item C @var{sig}
22972 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22973 @item s
22974 Step.
22975 @item S @var{sig}
22976 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22977 @end table
22978
22979 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
22980 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
22981
22982 Reply:
22983 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22984
22985 @item vCont?
22986 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
22987 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
22988
22989 Reply:
22990 @table @samp
22991 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
22992 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
22993 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
22994 @item
22995 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
22996 @end table
22997
22998 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22999 @anchor{X packet}
23000 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23001 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23002 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23003 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23004
23005 Reply:
23006 @table @samp
23007 @item OK
23008 for success
23009 @item E @var{NN}
23010 for an error
23011 @end table
23012
23013 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23014 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23015 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23016 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23017 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23018 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23019 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23020 @var{length} bytes.
23021
23022 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23023 separately.
23024
23025 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23026 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23027 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23028 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23029 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23030 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23031
23032 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23033 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23034 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23035 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23036 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23037 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23038
23039 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23040 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23041 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23042 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23043 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23044
23045 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23046 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23047 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23048 target, is not defined.}
23049
23050 Reply:
23051 @table @samp
23052 @item OK
23053 success
23054 @item
23055 not supported
23056 @item E @var{NN}
23057 for an error
23058 @end table
23059
23060 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23061 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23062 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23063 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23064 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23065 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23066
23067 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23068 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23069
23070 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23071 movement.}
23072
23073 Reply:
23074 @table @samp
23075 @item OK
23076 success
23077 @item
23078 not supported
23079 @item E @var{NN}
23080 for an error
23081 @end table
23082
23083 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23084 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23085 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23086 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23087 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23088
23089 Reply:
23090 @table @samp
23091 @item OK
23092 success
23093 @item
23094 not supported
23095 @item E @var{NN}
23096 for an error
23097 @end table
23098
23099 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23100 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23101 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23102 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23103 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23104
23105 Reply:
23106 @table @samp
23107 @item OK
23108 success
23109 @item
23110 not supported
23111 @item E @var{NN}
23112 for an error
23113 @end table
23114
23115 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23116 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23117 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23118 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23119 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23120
23121 Reply:
23122 @table @samp
23123 @item OK
23124 success
23125 @item
23126 not supported
23127 @item E @var{NN}
23128 for an error
23129 @end table
23130
23131 @end table
23132
23133 @node Stop Reply Packets
23134 @section Stop Reply Packets
23135 @cindex stop reply packets
23136
23137 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23138 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23139 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23140 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23141 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal
23142 numbering conventions is used.
23143
23144 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23145 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23146 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23147 components.
23148
23149 @table @samp
23150
23151 @item S @var{AA}
23152 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexidecimal
23153 number).
23154
23155 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23156 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23157 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexidecimal
23158 number). Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported this way. The
23159 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs give the values of important registers or
23160 other information:
23161 @enumerate
23162 @item
23163 If @var{n} is a hexidecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23164 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23165 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23166 two-digit hex number.
23167 @item
23168 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23169 hex.
23170 @item
23171 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23172 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23173 hex.
23174 @item
23175 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23176 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23177 future.
23178 @end enumerate
23179
23180 @item W @var{AA}
23181 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23182 applicable to certain targets.
23183
23184 @item X @var{AA}
23185 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23186
23187 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23188 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23189 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23190 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23191 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23192
23193 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23194 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23195 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23196 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23197 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23198 system calls.
23199
23200 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23201 this very system call.
23202
23203 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23204 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23205 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23206 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23207 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23208 protocol extension}, for more details.
23209
23210 @end table
23211
23212 @node General Query Packets
23213 @section General Query Packets
23214 @cindex remote query requests
23215
23216 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23217 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23218 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23219 sending information to and from the stub.
23220
23221 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23222 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23223 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23224 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23225 conventions:
23226
23227 @itemize @bullet
23228 @item
23229 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23230 @item
23231 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23232 letter.
23233 @item
23234 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23235 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23236 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23237 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23238 @end itemize
23239
23240 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23241 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23242 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23243 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23244 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23245 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23246 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23247 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23248 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23249 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23250 packet.}.
23251
23252 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23253 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23254 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23255 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23256 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23257
23258 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23259
23260 @table @samp
23261
23262 @item qC
23263 @cindex current thread, remote request
23264 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23265 Return the current thread id.
23266
23267 Reply:
23268 @table @samp
23269 @item QC @var{pid}
23270 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexidecimal process id.
23271 @item @r{(anything else)}
23272 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23273 @end table
23274
23275 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23276 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23277 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23278 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23279 Reply:
23280 @table @samp
23281 @item E @var{NN}
23282 An error (such as memory fault)
23283 @item C @var{crc32}
23284 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23285 @end table
23286
23287 @item qfThreadInfo
23288 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23289 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23290 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23291 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23292 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23293 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23294 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23295 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23296 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23297 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23298
23299 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23300
23301 Reply:
23302 @table @samp
23303 @item m @var{id}
23304 A single thread id
23305 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23306 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23307 @item l
23308 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23309 @end table
23310
23311 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23312 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23313 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23314 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23315 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23316
23317 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23318 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23319 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23320 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23321 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23322
23323 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23324 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23325
23326 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23327 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23328 information associated with the variable.)
23329
23330 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23331 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23332 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23333 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23334 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23335 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23336
23337 Reply:
23338 @table @samp
23339 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23340 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23341 local storage requested.
23342
23343 @item E @var{nn}
23344 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23345
23346 @item
23347 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23348 @end table
23349
23350 Use of this request packet is controlled by the @code{set remote
23351 get-thread-local-storage-address} command (@pxref{Remote
23352 configuration, set remote get-thread-local-storage-address}).
23353
23354 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23355 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23356 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23357 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23358 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23359 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23360 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23361
23362 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23363
23364 Reply:
23365 @table @samp
23366 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23367 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23368 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23369 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23370 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23371 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23372 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23373 @end table
23374
23375 @item qOffsets
23376 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23377 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23378 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23379 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23380 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23381 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23382
23383 Reply:
23384 @table @samp
23385 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23386 @end table
23387
23388 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23389 @cindex thread information, remote request
23390 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23391 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23392 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23393
23394 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23395 (see below).
23396
23397 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23398
23399 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23400 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23401 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23402 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23403 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23404 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23405 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23406 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23407 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23408
23409 Reply:
23410 @table @samp
23411 @item OK
23412 A command response with no output.
23413 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23414 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23415 @item E @var{NN}
23416 Indicate a badly formed request.
23417 @item
23418 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23419 @end table
23420
23421 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23422 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23423 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23424 packets.)
23425
23426 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23427 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23428 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23429 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23430 @anchor{qSupported}
23431 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23432 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23433 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23434 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23435 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23436 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23437 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23438 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23439 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23440 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23441 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23442 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23443 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23444 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23445
23446 Reply:
23447 @table @samp
23448 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23449 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23450 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23451 possible forms).
23452 @item
23453 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23454 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23455 @end table
23456
23457 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23458 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23459 are:
23460
23461 @table @samp
23462 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23463 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23464 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23465 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23466 @item @var{name}+
23467 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23468 need an associated value.
23469 @item @var{name}-
23470 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23471 @item @var{name}?
23472 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23473 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23474 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23475 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23476 @end table
23477
23478 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23479 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23480 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23481 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23482 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23483
23484 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23485 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23486 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23487 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23488 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23489 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23490 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23491 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23492 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23493 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23494 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23495 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23496 all the features it supports.
23497
23498 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23499 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23500
23501 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23502 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23503 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23504 form response.
23505
23506 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23507 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23508 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23509 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23510
23511 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23512 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23513 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23514 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23515 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23516
23517 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23518
23519 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23520 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23521 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23522 @item Feature Name
23523 @tab Value Required
23524 @tab Default
23525 @tab Probe Allowed
23526
23527 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23528 @tab Yes
23529 @tab @samp{-}
23530 @tab No
23531
23532 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23533 @tab No
23534 @tab @samp{-}
23535 @tab Yes
23536
23537 @end multitable
23538
23539 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23540
23541 @table @samp
23542 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23543 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23544 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23545 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23546 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23547 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23548 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23549 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23550 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23551 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23552
23553 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23554 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23555 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23556
23557 @end table
23558
23559 @item qSymbol::
23560 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23561 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23562 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23563 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23564
23565 Reply:
23566 @table @samp
23567 @item OK
23568 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23569 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23570 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23571 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23572 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23573 below.
23574 @end table
23575
23576 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23577 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23578
23579 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23580 target has previously requested.
23581
23582 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23583 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23584 will be empty.
23585
23586 Reply:
23587 @table @samp
23588 @item OK
23589 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23590 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23591 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23592 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23593 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23594 @end table
23595
23596 @item QTDP
23597 @itemx QTFrame
23598 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23599
23600 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23601 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23602 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23603 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23604 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23605 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23606 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23607 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23608 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23609 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23610
23611 Reply:
23612 @table @samp
23613 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23614 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23615 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23616 the thread's attributes.
23617 @end table
23618
23619 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23620 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23621 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23622 packets.)
23623
23624 @item QTStart
23625 @itemx QTStop
23626 @itemx QTinit
23627 @itemx QTro
23628 @itemx qTStatus
23629 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23630
23631 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23632 @cindex read special object, remote request
23633 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23634 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23635 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23636 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23637 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23638 additional details about what data to access.
23639
23640 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23641 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23642 formats, listed below.
23643
23644 @table @samp
23645 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23646 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23647 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23648 auxiliary vector}, and @ref{Remote configuration,
23649 read-aux-vector-packet}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23650
23651 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23652 by suppling an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23653 @end table
23654
23655 Reply:
23656 @table @samp
23657 @item m @var{data}
23658 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23659 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23660 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23661 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23662 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23663 request.
23664
23665 @item l @var{data}
23666 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23667 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23668 than the @var{length} in the request.
23669
23670 @item l
23671 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23672 There is no more data to be read.
23673
23674 @item E00
23675 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23676
23677 @item E @var{nn}
23678 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23679 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23680
23681 @item
23682 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23683 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23684 @end table
23685
23686 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23687 @cindex write data into object, remote request
23688 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23689 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23690 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
23691 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
23692 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
23693 to access.
23694
23695 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
23696 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
23697 specific request specifications ought to use.
23698
23699 Reply:
23700 @table @samp
23701 @item @var{nn}
23702 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23703 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23704
23705 @item E00
23706 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23707
23708 @item E @var{nn}
23709 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23710 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23711
23712 @item
23713 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
23714 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23715 @end table
23716
23717 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23718 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23719 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23720 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
23721 must respond with an empty packet.
23722
23723 @end table
23724
23725 @node Register Packet Format
23726 @section Register Packet Format
23727
23728 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23729 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23730 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23731 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
23732 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
23733 most-significant - least-significant.
23734
23735 @table @r
23736
23737 @item MIPS32
23738
23739 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
23740 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23741 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23742
23743 @item MIPS64
23744
23745 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23746 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23747 as @code{MIPS32}.
23748
23749 @end table
23750
23751 @node Tracepoint Packets
23752 @section Tracepoint Packets
23753 @cindex tracepoint packets
23754 @cindex packets, tracepoint
23755
23756 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
23757 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
23758
23759 @table @samp
23760
23761 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
23762 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
23763 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
23764 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
23765 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
23766 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
23767 tracepoint's actions.
23768
23769 Replies:
23770 @table @samp
23771 @item OK
23772 The packet was understood and carried out.
23773 @item
23774 The packet was not recognized.
23775 @end table
23776
23777 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
23778 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
23779 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
23780 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
23781 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
23782 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
23783 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
23784
23785 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
23786 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
23787 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
23788 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
23789 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
23790 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
23791 tracepoint actions.
23792
23793 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
23794 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
23795 following forms:
23796
23797 @table @samp
23798
23799 @item R @var{mask}
23800 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
23801 a hexidecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
23802 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
23803 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
23804 not fit in a 32-bit word.
23805
23806 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
23807 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
23808 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
23809 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
23810 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
23811 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexidecimal
23812 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
23813
23814 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
23815 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
23816 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
23817 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
23818 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
23819 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
23820 packet).
23821
23822 @end table
23823
23824 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
23825 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
23826 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
23827 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
23828 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
23829 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
23830 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
23831 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
23832
23833 Replies:
23834 @table @samp
23835 @item OK
23836 The packet was understood and carried out.
23837 @item
23838 The packet was not recognized.
23839 @end table
23840
23841 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
23842 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
23843 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
23844 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
23845
23846 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
23847 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
23848 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
23849 one of the following forms:
23850
23851 @table @samp
23852 @item F @var{f}
23853 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
23854 @var{f} is a hexidecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
23855 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
23856
23857 @item T @var{t}
23858 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
23859 @var{t} is a hexidecimal number.
23860
23861 @end table
23862
23863 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
23864 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23865 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
23866 @var{addr} is a hexidecimal number.
23867
23868 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
23869 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23870 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
23871 is a hexidecimal number.
23872
23873 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
23874 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23875 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
23876 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexidecimal
23877 numbers.
23878
23879 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
23880 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
23881 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
23882
23883 @item QTStart
23884 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
23885 hits in the trace frame buffer.
23886
23887 @item QTStop
23888 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
23889
23890 @item QTinit
23891 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
23892
23893 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
23894 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
23895 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
23896 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
23897
23898 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
23899 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
23900 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
23901 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
23902
23903 @item qTStatus
23904 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
23905
23906 Replies:
23907 @table @samp
23908 @item T0
23909 There is no trace experiment running.
23910 @item T1
23911 There is a trace experiment running.
23912 @end table
23913
23914 @end table
23915
23916
23917 @node Interrupts
23918 @section Interrupts
23919 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
23920
23921 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
23922 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
23923 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
23924 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
23925
23926 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
23927 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
23928 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
23929 interfaces.
23930
23931 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
23932 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
23933 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
23934 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
23935 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
23936 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
23937 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
23938 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
23939
23940 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
23941 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
23942 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
23943 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
23944 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
23945 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
23946 program is stopped will be discarded.
23947
23948 @node Examples
23949 @section Examples
23950
23951 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
23952 does not get any direct output:
23953
23954 @smallexample
23955 -> @code{R00}
23956 <- @code{+}
23957 @emph{target restarts}
23958 -> @code{?}
23959 <- @code{+}
23960 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
23961 -> @code{+}
23962 @end smallexample
23963
23964 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
23965
23966 @smallexample
23967 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
23968 <- @code{+}
23969 -> @code{s}
23970 <- @code{+}
23971 @emph{time passes}
23972 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
23973 -> @code{+}
23974 -> @code{g}
23975 <- @code{+}
23976 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
23977 -> @code{+}
23978 @end smallexample
23979
23980 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
23981 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
23982 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
23983
23984 @menu
23985 * File-I/O Overview::
23986 * Protocol basics::
23987 * The F request packet::
23988 * The F reply packet::
23989 * The Ctrl-C message::
23990 * Console I/O::
23991 * List of supported calls::
23992 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
23993 * Constants::
23994 * File-I/O Examples::
23995 @end menu
23996
23997 @node File-I/O Overview
23998 @subsection File-I/O Overview
23999 @cindex file-i/o overview
24000
24001 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24002 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24003 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24004 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24005 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24006 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24007
24008 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24009 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24010 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24011 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24012 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24013
24014 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24015 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24016 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24017 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24018 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24019 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24020 (Ctrl-C) within @value{GDBN}.
24021
24022 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24023 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24024 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24025 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24026 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24027
24028 @smallexample
24029 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24030 <- target requests 'system call X'
24031 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24032 -> GDB returns result
24033 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
24034 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24035 @end smallexample
24036
24037 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24038 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24039 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24040 system are not supported by this protocol.
24041
24042 @node Protocol basics
24043 @subsection Protocol basics
24044 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24045
24046 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24047 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24048 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24049 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24050 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24051 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24052 to call the appropriate host system call:
24053
24054 @itemize @bullet
24055 @item
24056 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24057
24058 @item
24059 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24060 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24061 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24062 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol specific representation.
24063
24064 @end itemize
24065
24066 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24067
24068 @itemize @bullet
24069 @item
24070 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24071 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24072 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24073 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24074 packet.
24075
24076 @item
24077 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24078 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24079
24080 @item
24081 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24082
24083 @item
24084 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24085
24086 @item
24087 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24088 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24089 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24090 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24091 packet.
24092
24093 @end itemize
24094
24095 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24096 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24097
24098 @itemize @bullet
24099 @item
24100 Return value.
24101
24102 @item
24103 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24104
24105 @item
24106 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24107
24108 @end itemize
24109
24110 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24111 the latest continue or step action.
24112
24113 @node The F request packet
24114 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
24115 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24116 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24117
24118 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24119
24120 @table @samp
24121 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24122
24123 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24124 This is just the name of the function.
24125
24126 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24127 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24128 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24129 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24130 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24131 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24132 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24133
24134 @end table
24135
24136
24137
24138 @node The F reply packet
24139 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
24140 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24141 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24142
24143 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24144
24145 @table @samp
24146
24147 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call specific attachment}
24148
24149 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24150
24151 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
24152 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24153
24154 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24155 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24156 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24157
24158 @smallexample
24159 F0,0,C
24160 @end smallexample
24161
24162 @noindent
24163 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24164
24165 @smallexample
24166 F-1,4,C
24167 @end smallexample
24168
24169 @noindent
24170 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24171
24172 @end table
24173
24174
24175 @node The Ctrl-C message
24176 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
24177 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24178
24179 If the Ctrl-C flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24180 reply packet (@pxref{The F reply packet}),
24181 the target should behave as if it had
24182 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24183 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24184 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24185 packet.
24186
24187 It's important for the target to know in which
24188 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24189
24190 @itemize @bullet
24191 @item
24192 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24193
24194 @item
24195 The system call on the host has been finished.
24196
24197 @end itemize
24198
24199 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24200 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24201 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24202 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24203 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24204 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24205
24206 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24207 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24208 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24209 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24210 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24211 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24212 or the full action has been completed.
24213
24214 @node Console I/O
24215 @subsection Console I/O
24216 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24217
24218 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
24219 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24220 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24221 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24222 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24223 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24224 conditions is met:
24225
24226 @itemize @bullet
24227 @item
24228 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24229 @code{read}
24230 system call is treated as finished.
24231
24232 @item
24233 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24234 newline.
24235
24236 @item
24237 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24238 character (neither newline nor Ctrl-D) is appended to the input.
24239
24240 @end itemize
24241
24242 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24243 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24244 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24245 is stopped at the user's request.
24246
24247
24248 @node List of supported calls
24249 @subsection List of supported calls
24250 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24251
24252 @menu
24253 * open::
24254 * close::
24255 * read::
24256 * write::
24257 * lseek::
24258 * rename::
24259 * unlink::
24260 * stat/fstat::
24261 * gettimeofday::
24262 * isatty::
24263 * system::
24264 @end menu
24265
24266 @node open
24267 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24268 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24269
24270 @table @asis
24271 @item Synopsis:
24272 @smallexample
24273 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24274 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24275 @end smallexample
24276
24277 @item Request:
24278 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24279
24280 @noindent
24281 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24282
24283 @table @code
24284 @item O_CREAT
24285 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24286 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24287 are concerned.
24288
24289 @item O_EXCL
24290 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24291 an error and open() fails.
24292
24293 @item O_TRUNC
24294 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24295 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24296 truncated to zero length.
24297
24298 @item O_APPEND
24299 The file is opened in append mode.
24300
24301 @item O_RDONLY
24302 The file is opened for reading only.
24303
24304 @item O_WRONLY
24305 The file is opened for writing only.
24306
24307 @item O_RDWR
24308 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24309 @end table
24310
24311 @noindent
24312 Other bits are silently ignored.
24313
24314
24315 @noindent
24316 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24317
24318 @table @code
24319 @item S_IRUSR
24320 User has read permission.
24321
24322 @item S_IWUSR
24323 User has write permission.
24324
24325 @item S_IRGRP
24326 Group has read permission.
24327
24328 @item S_IWGRP
24329 Group has write permission.
24330
24331 @item S_IROTH
24332 Others have read permission.
24333
24334 @item S_IWOTH
24335 Others have write permission.
24336 @end table
24337
24338 @noindent
24339 Other bits are silently ignored.
24340
24341
24342 @item Return value:
24343 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24344 occurred.
24345
24346 @item Errors:
24347
24348 @table @code
24349 @item EEXIST
24350 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24351
24352 @item EISDIR
24353 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24354
24355 @item EACCES
24356 The requested access is not allowed.
24357
24358 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24359 @var{pathname} was too long.
24360
24361 @item ENOENT
24362 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24363
24364 @item ENODEV
24365 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24366
24367 @item EROFS
24368 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24369 write access was requested.
24370
24371 @item EFAULT
24372 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24373
24374 @item ENOSPC
24375 No space on device to create the file.
24376
24377 @item EMFILE
24378 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24379
24380 @item ENFILE
24381 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24382 has been reached.
24383
24384 @item EINTR
24385 The call was interrupted by the user.
24386 @end table
24387
24388 @end table
24389
24390 @node close
24391 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24392 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24393
24394 @table @asis
24395 @item Synopsis:
24396 @smallexample
24397 int close(int fd);
24398 @end smallexample
24399
24400 @item Request:
24401 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24402
24403 @item Return value:
24404 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24405
24406 @item Errors:
24407
24408 @table @code
24409 @item EBADF
24410 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24411
24412 @item EINTR
24413 The call was interrupted by the user.
24414 @end table
24415
24416 @end table
24417
24418 @node read
24419 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24420 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24421
24422 @table @asis
24423 @item Synopsis:
24424 @smallexample
24425 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24426 @end smallexample
24427
24428 @item Request:
24429 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24430
24431 @item Return value:
24432 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24433 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24434 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24435
24436 @item Errors:
24437
24438 @table @code
24439 @item EBADF
24440 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24441 reading.
24442
24443 @item EFAULT
24444 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24445
24446 @item EINTR
24447 The call was interrupted by the user.
24448 @end table
24449
24450 @end table
24451
24452 @node write
24453 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24454 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24455
24456 @table @asis
24457 @item Synopsis:
24458 @smallexample
24459 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24460 @end smallexample
24461
24462 @item Request:
24463 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24464
24465 @item Return value:
24466 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24467 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24468 is returned.
24469
24470 @item Errors:
24471
24472 @table @code
24473 @item EBADF
24474 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24475 writing.
24476
24477 @item EFAULT
24478 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24479
24480 @item EFBIG
24481 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24482 host specific maximum file size allowed.
24483
24484 @item ENOSPC
24485 No space on device to write the data.
24486
24487 @item EINTR
24488 The call was interrupted by the user.
24489 @end table
24490
24491 @end table
24492
24493 @node lseek
24494 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24495 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24496
24497 @table @asis
24498 @item Synopsis:
24499 @smallexample
24500 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24501 @end smallexample
24502
24503 @item Request:
24504 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24505
24506 @var{flag} is one of:
24507
24508 @table @code
24509 @item SEEK_SET
24510 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24511
24512 @item SEEK_CUR
24513 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24514 bytes.
24515
24516 @item SEEK_END
24517 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24518 bytes.
24519 @end table
24520
24521 @item Return value:
24522 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24523 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24524 value of -1 is returned.
24525
24526 @item Errors:
24527
24528 @table @code
24529 @item EBADF
24530 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24531
24532 @item ESPIPE
24533 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24534
24535 @item EINVAL
24536 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24537
24538 @item EINTR
24539 The call was interrupted by the user.
24540 @end table
24541
24542 @end table
24543
24544 @node rename
24545 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24546 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24547
24548 @table @asis
24549 @item Synopsis:
24550 @smallexample
24551 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24552 @end smallexample
24553
24554 @item Request:
24555 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24556
24557 @item Return value:
24558 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24559
24560 @item Errors:
24561
24562 @table @code
24563 @item EISDIR
24564 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24565 directory.
24566
24567 @item EEXIST
24568 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24569
24570 @item EBUSY
24571 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24572 process.
24573
24574 @item EINVAL
24575 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24576 of itself.
24577
24578 @item ENOTDIR
24579 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24580 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24581 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24582
24583 @item EFAULT
24584 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24585
24586 @item EACCES
24587 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24588
24589 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24590
24591 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24592
24593 @item ENOENT
24594 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24595
24596 @item EROFS
24597 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24598
24599 @item ENOSPC
24600 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24601 directory entry.
24602
24603 @item EINTR
24604 The call was interrupted by the user.
24605 @end table
24606
24607 @end table
24608
24609 @node unlink
24610 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24611 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24612
24613 @table @asis
24614 @item Synopsis:
24615 @smallexample
24616 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24617 @end smallexample
24618
24619 @item Request:
24620 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24621
24622 @item Return value:
24623 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24624
24625 @item Errors:
24626
24627 @table @code
24628 @item EACCES
24629 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24630
24631 @item EPERM
24632 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24633
24634 @item EBUSY
24635 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24636 being used by another process.
24637
24638 @item EFAULT
24639 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24640
24641 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24642 @var{pathname} was too long.
24643
24644 @item ENOENT
24645 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24646
24647 @item ENOTDIR
24648 A component of the path is not a directory.
24649
24650 @item EROFS
24651 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24652
24653 @item EINTR
24654 The call was interrupted by the user.
24655 @end table
24656
24657 @end table
24658
24659 @node stat/fstat
24660 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24661 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24662 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24663
24664 @table @asis
24665 @item Synopsis:
24666 @smallexample
24667 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24668 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24669 @end smallexample
24670
24671 @item Request:
24672 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24673 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
24674
24675 @item Return value:
24676 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24677
24678 @item Errors:
24679
24680 @table @code
24681 @item EBADF
24682 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
24683
24684 @item ENOENT
24685 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
24686 path is an empty string.
24687
24688 @item ENOTDIR
24689 A component of the path is not a directory.
24690
24691 @item EFAULT
24692 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24693
24694 @item EACCES
24695 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24696
24697 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24698 @var{pathname} was too long.
24699
24700 @item EINTR
24701 The call was interrupted by the user.
24702 @end table
24703
24704 @end table
24705
24706 @node gettimeofday
24707 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24708 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24709
24710 @table @asis
24711 @item Synopsis:
24712 @smallexample
24713 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24714 @end smallexample
24715
24716 @item Request:
24717 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
24718
24719 @item Return value:
24720 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
24721
24722 @item Errors:
24723
24724 @table @code
24725 @item EINVAL
24726 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
24727
24728 @item EFAULT
24729 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24730 @end table
24731
24732 @end table
24733
24734 @node isatty
24735 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
24736 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
24737
24738 @table @asis
24739 @item Synopsis:
24740 @smallexample
24741 int isatty(int fd);
24742 @end smallexample
24743
24744 @item Request:
24745 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
24746
24747 @item Return value:
24748 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
24749
24750 @item Errors:
24751
24752 @table @code
24753 @item EINTR
24754 The call was interrupted by the user.
24755 @end table
24756
24757 @end table
24758
24759 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
24760 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
24761 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
24762 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
24763 needed.
24764
24765
24766 @node system
24767 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
24768 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
24769
24770 @table @asis
24771 @item Synopsis:
24772 @smallexample
24773 int system(const char *command);
24774 @end smallexample
24775
24776 @item Request:
24777 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
24778
24779 @item Return value:
24780 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
24781 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
24782 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
24783 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
24784 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
24785 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
24786 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
24787
24788 @item Errors:
24789
24790 @table @code
24791 @item EINTR
24792 The call was interrupted by the user.
24793 @end table
24794
24795 @end table
24796
24797 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
24798 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
24799 the host is simplified before it's returned
24800 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
24801 is discarded, and the return value consists
24802 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
24803
24804 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
24805 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
24806 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
24807
24808 @table @code
24809 @item set remote system-call-allowed
24810 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
24811 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
24812 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
24813
24814 @item show remote system-call-allowed
24815 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
24816 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
24817 protocol.
24818 @end table
24819
24820 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
24821 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
24822 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
24823
24824 @menu
24825 * Integral datatypes::
24826 * Pointer values::
24827 * Memory transfer::
24828 * struct stat::
24829 * struct timeval::
24830 @end menu
24831
24832 @node Integral datatypes
24833 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
24834 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
24835
24836 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
24837 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
24838 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
24839
24840 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
24841 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
24842
24843 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
24844
24845 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
24846 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
24847
24848 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
24849
24850 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
24851 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
24852 byte order.
24853
24854 @node Pointer values
24855 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
24856 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
24857
24858 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
24859 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
24860 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
24861 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
24862
24863 @smallexample
24864 @code{1aaf/12}
24865 @end smallexample
24866
24867 @noindent
24868 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
24869 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
24870 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
24871 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
24872
24873 @smallexample
24874 @code{123456/d}
24875 @end smallexample
24876
24877 @node Memory transfer
24878 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory transfer
24879 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
24880
24881 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
24882 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol specific format
24883 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
24884 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
24885 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
24886 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
24887 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
24888
24889
24890 @node struct stat
24891 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
24892 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
24893
24894 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
24895 is defined as follows:
24896
24897 @smallexample
24898 struct stat @{
24899 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
24900 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
24901 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
24902 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
24903 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
24904 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
24905 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
24906 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
24907 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
24908 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
24909 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
24910 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
24911 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
24912 @};
24913 @end smallexample
24914
24915 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
24916 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
24917 structure is of size 64 bytes.
24918
24919 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
24920 range of values.
24921
24922 @table @code
24923
24924 @item st_dev
24925 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
24926
24927 @item st_ino
24928 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24929
24930 @item st_mode
24931 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
24932 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
24933
24934 @item st_uid
24935 @itemx st_gid
24936 @itemx st_rdev
24937 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
24938
24939 @item st_atime
24940 @itemx st_mtime
24941 @itemx st_ctime
24942 These values have a host and file system dependent
24943 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
24944 support exact timing values.
24945 @end table
24946
24947 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
24948 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
24949 continuing.
24950
24951 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
24952 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
24953 get truncated on the target.
24954
24955 @node struct timeval
24956 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
24957 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
24958
24959 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
24960 is defined as follows:
24961
24962 @smallexample
24963 struct timeval @{
24964 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
24965 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
24966 @};
24967 @end smallexample
24968
24969 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
24970 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
24971 structure is of size 8 bytes.
24972
24973 @node Constants
24974 @subsection Constants
24975 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
24976
24977 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
24978 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
24979 values before and after the call as needed.
24980
24981 @menu
24982 * Open flags::
24983 * mode_t values::
24984 * Errno values::
24985 * Lseek flags::
24986 * Limits::
24987 @end menu
24988
24989 @node Open flags
24990 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
24991 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
24992
24993 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
24994
24995 @smallexample
24996 O_RDONLY 0x0
24997 O_WRONLY 0x1
24998 O_RDWR 0x2
24999 O_APPEND 0x8
25000 O_CREAT 0x200
25001 O_TRUNC 0x400
25002 O_EXCL 0x800
25003 @end smallexample
25004
25005 @node mode_t values
25006 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
25007 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25008
25009 All values are given in octal representation.
25010
25011 @smallexample
25012 S_IFREG 0100000
25013 S_IFDIR 040000
25014 S_IRUSR 0400
25015 S_IWUSR 0200
25016 S_IXUSR 0100
25017 S_IRGRP 040
25018 S_IWGRP 020
25019 S_IXGRP 010
25020 S_IROTH 04
25021 S_IWOTH 02
25022 S_IXOTH 01
25023 @end smallexample
25024
25025 @node Errno values
25026 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
25027 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25028
25029 All values are given in decimal representation.
25030
25031 @smallexample
25032 EPERM 1
25033 ENOENT 2
25034 EINTR 4
25035 EBADF 9
25036 EACCES 13
25037 EFAULT 14
25038 EBUSY 16
25039 EEXIST 17
25040 ENODEV 19
25041 ENOTDIR 20
25042 EISDIR 21
25043 EINVAL 22
25044 ENFILE 23
25045 EMFILE 24
25046 EFBIG 27
25047 ENOSPC 28
25048 ESPIPE 29
25049 EROFS 30
25050 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25051 EUNKNOWN 9999
25052 @end smallexample
25053
25054 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25055 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25056
25057 @node Lseek flags
25058 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
25059 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25060
25061 @smallexample
25062 SEEK_SET 0
25063 SEEK_CUR 1
25064 SEEK_END 2
25065 @end smallexample
25066
25067 @node Limits
25068 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25069 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25070
25071 All values are given in decimal representation.
25072
25073 @smallexample
25074 INT_MIN -2147483648
25075 INT_MAX 2147483647
25076 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25077 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25078 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25079 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25080 @end smallexample
25081
25082 @node File-I/O Examples
25083 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25084 @cindex file-i/o examples
25085
25086 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25087 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25088
25089 @smallexample
25090 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25091 @emph{request memory read from target}
25092 -> @code{m1234,6}
25093 <- XXXXXX
25094 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25095 -> @code{F6}
25096 @end smallexample
25097
25098 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25099 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25100
25101 @smallexample
25102 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25103 @emph{request memory write to target}
25104 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25105 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25106 -> @code{F6}
25107 @end smallexample
25108
25109 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25110 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25111
25112 @smallexample
25113 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25114 -> @code{F-1,9}
25115 @end smallexample
25116
25117 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
25118 host is called:
25119
25120 @smallexample
25121 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25122 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25123 <- @code{T02}
25124 @end smallexample
25125
25126 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
25127 host is called:
25128
25129 @smallexample
25130 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25131 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25132 <- @code{T02}
25133 @end smallexample
25134
25135 @include agentexpr.texi
25136
25137 @include gpl.texi
25138
25139 @raisesections
25140 @include fdl.texi
25141 @lowersections
25142
25143 @node Index
25144 @unnumbered Index
25145
25146 @printindex cp
25147
25148 @tex
25149 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25150 % meantime:
25151 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25152 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25153 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25154 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25155 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25156 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25157 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25158 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25159 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25160 \page\colophon
25161 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25162 @end tex
25163
25164 @bye
This page took 0.533987 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.